1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H 2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H 3 /* 4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header 5 * 6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net> 8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com> 9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch> 10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com> 11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com> 12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com> 13 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2023 Intel Corporation 15 * 16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any 17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above 18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. 19 * 20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES 21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF 22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR 23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES 24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN 25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF 26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. 27 * 28 */ 29 30 /* 31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please 32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so 33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI. 34 * 35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in 36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there 37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are 38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API 39 * can actually be identified and removed. 40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file. 41 */ 42 43 #include <linux/types.h> 44 45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211" 46 47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG "config" 48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN "scan" 49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG "regulatory" 50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME "mlme" 51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR "vendor" 52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN "nan" 53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE "testmode" 54 55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN 4 56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX 15 57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN 1 58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX 0x3c /* 0b00111100 */ 59 60 /** 61 * DOC: Station handling 62 * 63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN 64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved 65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN). 66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added 67 * to. 68 * 69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's 70 * capabilities. 71 * 72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS 73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows: 74 * - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate 75 * or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions 76 * - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid 77 * to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same 78 * time mark it authorized. 79 * - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used 80 * - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down 81 * the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK) 82 * 83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types 84 */ 85 86 /** 87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support 88 * 89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace 90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames 91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example, 92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel 93 * for various reasons. 94 * 95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations 96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to 97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a 98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those 99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the 100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility 101 * for doing that. 102 * 103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the 104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy 105 * attributes so applications know what to expect. 106 * 107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active, 108 * these registrations are ignored until the interface type is 109 * changed again. This means that changing the interface type can 110 * lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but 111 * any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they 112 * will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames. 113 * 114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required 115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking, 116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its 117 * status is indicated to the sending socket. 118 * 119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions 120 * below. 121 */ 122 123 /** 124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities 125 * 126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have 127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this 128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions 129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported. 130 * 131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in 132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the 133 * types there no concurrency is implied. 134 * 135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed: 136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in 137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's 138 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and 139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN 140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list 141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute. 142 * 143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is 144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically, 145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the 146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of 147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions 148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported 149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially 150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 151 * 152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual 153 * interfaces that a given device supports. 154 */ 155 156 /** 157 * DOC: packet coalesce support 158 * 159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast 160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the 161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing 162 * and power consumption. 163 * 164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts 165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some 166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the 167 * following events occur. 168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum 169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule. 170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit. 171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules. 172 * 173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce 174 * rule. 175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay 176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched 177 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match' 178 * Multiple such rules can be created. 179 */ 180 181 /** 182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload 183 * 184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers 185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no 189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 191 * 192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be 193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL 194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to 195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have 196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this 197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is 198 * not present. 199 * 200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers 201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no 205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 207 * 208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also 210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided. 211 */ 212 213 /** 214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload 215 * 216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by 217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the 219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and 220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional 221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in 222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS. 223 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai 224 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai 225 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message 226 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK 227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and 228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA. 229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used 230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696. 231 * 232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the 233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting 234 * up a connection or after roaming. 235 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal 236 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges 237 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated 238 * %Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace 239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used 240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also. 241 * 242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS 243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the 244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and 245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based 246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with 247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to 248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching. 249 */ 250 251 /** 252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload 253 * 254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station 256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by 257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode. 258 * 259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in 260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode 261 * respectively. 262 */ 263 264 /** 265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs 266 * 267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a 269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs 270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet 271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are 272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through 273 * that main netdev. 274 * 275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and 276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using 277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID. 278 */ 279 280 /** 281 * DOC: TID configuration 282 * 283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG 284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities. 285 * 286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in 287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the 288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG. 289 * 290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC 291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the 292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except 293 * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if 294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values 295 * will be overwritten. 296 * 297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection 298 * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back 299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when 300 * the interface goes down. 301 */ 302 303 /** 304 * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload 305 * 306 * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode. 307 * 308 * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting 309 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 310 * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt 311 * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai. 312 * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace. 313 * 314 * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the 315 * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association 316 * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters 317 * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 318 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA 319 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption 320 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption 321 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 322 * 323 * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data. 324 */ 325 326 /** 327 * DOC: Multi-Link Operation 328 * 329 * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple 330 * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need 331 * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute. 332 * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link 333 * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to 334 * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions. 335 */ 336 337 /** 338 * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload 339 * 340 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate 341 * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is 342 * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and 343 * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK. 344 */ 345 346 /** 347 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands 348 * 349 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors 350 * 351 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request 352 * to get a list of all present wiphys. 353 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or 354 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 355 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 356 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the 357 * channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel), 358 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 359 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or 360 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD. However, for setting the channel, 361 * see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward 362 * compatibility only. 363 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request 364 * or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and 365 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 366 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes 367 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 368 * 369 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration; 370 * either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a 371 * single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported. 372 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires 373 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE. 374 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response 375 * to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 376 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also 377 * be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface, 378 * then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and 379 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME. 380 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes 381 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from 382 * userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires 383 * attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are 384 * enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 385 * and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all 386 * the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well. 387 * 388 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified 389 * by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 390 * represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key, 391 * the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 392 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 393 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD. 394 * For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by 395 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 396 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 397 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 398 * and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents 399 * peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO 400 * group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 401 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX 402 * or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address 403 * for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by 404 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 405 * 406 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used) 407 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface 408 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL 409 * attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses 410 * internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE, 411 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP. 412 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters 413 * are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that 414 * do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 415 * %NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 416 * %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE, 417 * %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 418 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 419 * %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 420 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS. 421 * The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the 422 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the 423 * attributes determining channel width. 424 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 425 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface 426 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP 427 * 428 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by 429 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 430 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by 431 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 432 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the 433 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 434 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 435 * or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified 436 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in 437 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and 438 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type 439 * of disconnection indication should be sent to the station 440 * (Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that 441 * frame). 442 * 443 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to 444 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 445 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 446 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH: Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to 447 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 448 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 449 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by 450 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP. 451 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by 452 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 453 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the 454 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 455 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 456 * or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified 457 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 458 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by 459 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 460 * 461 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set 462 * regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device 463 * has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the 464 * global regdomain will be returned. 465 * A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the 466 * regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel 467 * information will still be mended according to further hints from 468 * the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API 469 * is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as 470 * all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it). 471 * If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then 472 * its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory 473 * core is not used to help with compliance in this case. 474 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command 475 * after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory 476 * domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our 477 * current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides 478 * NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each 479 * regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes given by 480 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and 481 * %NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by 482 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and 483 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP. 484 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain 485 * to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will 486 * store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it. 487 * 488 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the 489 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 490 * 491 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the 492 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 493 * 494 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The 495 * interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management 496 * frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be 497 * added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with 498 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be 499 * added to all specified management frames generated by 500 * kernel/firmware/driver. 501 * Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this 502 * point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this 503 * command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the 504 * option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 505 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 506 * NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 507 * 508 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results 509 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters 510 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 511 * probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to 512 * specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will 513 * be used. 514 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to 515 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group) 516 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons, 517 * partial scan results may be available 518 * 519 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain 520 * intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by 521 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is 522 * not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified, 523 * scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval. 524 * These attributes are mutually exculsive, 525 * i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if 526 * NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined. 527 * If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan 528 * plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet). 529 * Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS) 530 * are passed, they are used in the probe requests. For 531 * broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty 532 * string). If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and 533 * a passive scan is performed. %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 534 * if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not 535 * passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain 536 * are used. Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by 537 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute. The first cycle of the 538 * scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY 539 * is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled 540 * scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute 541 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it. 542 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if 543 * scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon 544 * as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again. 545 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan 546 * results available. 547 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has 548 * stopped. The driver may issue this event at any time during a 549 * scheduled scan. One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware 550 * does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running 551 * a scheduled scan. This event is also sent when the 552 * %NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface 553 * is brought down while a scheduled scan was running. 554 * 555 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation 556 * or noise level 557 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to 558 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group) 559 * 560 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 561 * (for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 562 * (PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or 563 * using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 564 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS 565 * authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier 566 * advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an 567 * ESS. 568 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 569 * (for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 570 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS 571 * authentication. 572 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries. 573 * 574 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain 575 * has been changed and provides details of the request information 576 * that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request 577 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx 578 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if 579 * the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or 580 * %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain 581 * set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is 582 * %NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on 583 * to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2). 584 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon 585 * has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or 586 * any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel 587 * where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example 588 * if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your 589 * driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while 590 * doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not 591 * on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP 592 * or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will 593 * never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always 594 * enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had 595 * either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to 596 * userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from 597 * (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred 598 * before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER) 599 * the beacon hint was processed. 600 * 601 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification. 602 * This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and 603 * as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the 604 * authentication process. 605 * When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the 606 * interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and 607 * BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify 608 * the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication 609 * request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ + 610 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the 611 * channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the 612 * authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs 613 * (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added 614 * to the frame. 615 * When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication 616 * frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the 617 * frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct 618 * state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the 619 * MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The 620 * included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame 621 * (including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is 622 * also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that 623 * case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a 624 * %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which 625 * pending authentication timed out). 626 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like 627 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation 628 * (similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request, 629 * MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The 630 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the 631 * request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not 632 * included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is 633 * included). 634 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like 635 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to 636 * MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication 637 * primitives). 638 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like 639 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to 640 * MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives). 641 * 642 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael 643 * MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the 644 * event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of 645 * the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key 646 * type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and 647 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this 648 * event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive 649 * 650 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a 651 * FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found) 652 * and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those 653 * should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be 654 * executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ 655 * may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval, 656 * given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not 657 * given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms). 658 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is 659 * determined by the network interface. 660 * 661 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute 662 * to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through 663 * to the driver. 664 * 665 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command 666 * requests to connect to a specified network but without separating 667 * auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a 668 * %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association 669 * IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 670 * %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 671 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 672 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 673 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 674 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and 675 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT. 676 * If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are 677 * restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming 678 * within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT 679 * can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while 680 * allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to 681 * ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one 682 * set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing 683 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict 684 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT). 685 * Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if 686 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is 687 * included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user 688 * space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends 689 * up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g. 690 * userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the 691 * driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE 692 * has to get updated with the apt PMKID). 693 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within 694 * the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with 695 * a different BSS is desired. 696 * Background scan period can optionally be 697 * specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 698 * if not specified default background scan configuration 699 * in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled. 700 * This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan. 701 * It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the 702 * connection is established or failed to be established. This can be 703 * determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success, 704 * non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the 705 * event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate 706 * authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP. 707 * Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as 708 * well to remain backwards compatible. 709 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself. 710 * When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using 711 * fast transition, this event should be followed by an 712 * %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event. 713 * Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue 714 * %NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the 715 * new BSS the card/driver roamed to. 716 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify 717 * userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other 718 * reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and 719 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used. 720 * 721 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices 722 * associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow. 723 * 724 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified 725 * channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do 726 * off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for 727 * a response while being associated to an AP on another channel. 728 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus 729 * radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the 730 * frequency for the operation. 731 * %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds 732 * to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to 733 * notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the 734 * driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the 735 * radio). 736 * When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 737 * that will be included with any events pertaining to this request; 738 * the cookie is also used to cancel the request. 739 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a 740 * pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been 741 * completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration. 742 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the 743 * radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to 744 * uniquely identify the request. 745 * This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested 746 * remain-on-channel duration has expired. 747 * 748 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX 749 * rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface 750 * and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates. 751 * 752 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames 753 * (via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command 754 * requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for 755 * backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames) 756 * and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame 757 * that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or 758 * four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration 759 * cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink 760 * socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made. 761 * The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if 762 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which 763 * case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the 764 * flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it. 765 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for 766 * backward compatibility 767 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This 768 * command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and 769 * as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in 770 * kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a 771 * user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 772 * frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used 773 * to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was 774 * received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel 775 * or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel 776 * and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time 777 * specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation 778 * returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the 779 * TX status event pertaining to the TX request. 780 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 781 * management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band. 782 * %NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA 783 * counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute 784 * is used during CSA period. 785 * For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be 786 * specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses 787 * in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by 788 * lower layers. 789 * For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 790 * indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may 791 * be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp. 792 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this 793 * command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait 794 * time if it is known that it is no longer necessary. This command is 795 * also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel 796 * wait time. 797 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility. 798 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame 799 * transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies 800 * the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the 801 * frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged 802 * the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the 803 * tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 804 * indicate the ack RX timestamp. 805 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for 806 * backward compatibility. 807 * 808 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 809 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 810 * 811 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command 812 * is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger 813 * levels. 814 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This 815 * command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was 816 * reached. 817 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 818 * and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface 819 * (identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on. 820 * In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism 821 * with which it switches channels is implementation-defined. 822 * When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while 823 * no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation 824 * of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take 825 * precedence when they are used. 826 * 827 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface 828 * (no longer supported). 829 * 830 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform 831 * multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets 832 * with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header) 833 * will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast) 834 * MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may 835 * break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop 836 * unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability 837 * to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases. 838 * This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of 839 * type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces 840 * (%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode. 841 * If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this 842 * command, the feature is disabled. 843 * 844 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial 845 * mesh config parameters may be given. 846 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the 847 * network is determined by the network interface. 848 * 849 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame 850 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 851 * deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 852 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame 853 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 854 * disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 855 * 856 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a 857 * beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer. This is only 858 * sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer 859 * candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 860 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or 861 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set. On reception of this 862 * notification, userspace may decide to create a new station 863 * (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). To stop this notification from 864 * reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the 865 * new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later 866 * depending on the authentication result. 867 * 868 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 869 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 870 * Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports 871 * various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this 872 * command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For 873 * more background information, see 874 * https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN. 875 * The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification 876 * from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the 877 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason 878 * for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present 879 * in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the 880 * wakeup but reports that it was woken up. 881 * 882 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver 883 * the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This 884 * feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data 885 * is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and 886 * contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened, 887 * this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to 888 * inform userspace of the new replay counter. 889 * 890 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace 891 * of PMKSA caching dandidates. 892 * 893 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup). 894 * In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take 895 * actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one). 896 * In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested 897 * operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and 898 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with 899 * %NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN). 900 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The 901 * %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be 902 * sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as 903 * 802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012 904 * 8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently 905 * supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES 906 * and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in 907 * &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode. 908 * 909 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP 910 * (or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to 911 * implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3 912 * frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame 913 * is received. 914 * For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and 915 * other attributes like the interface index are present. 916 * If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can 917 * only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription 918 * is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events. 919 * 920 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the 921 * associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame 922 * and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly 923 * to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener. 924 * 925 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface 926 * by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is 927 * acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses 928 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a 929 * direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match 930 * up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and 931 * has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed. 932 * 933 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from 934 * other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement 935 * OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME 936 * messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register. 937 * 938 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether 939 * No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied. 940 * 941 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels 942 * independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating 943 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the 944 * attributes determining channel width. This indication may also be 945 * sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA 946 * from the remote AP) is completed; 947 * 948 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch 949 * has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator 950 * (ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or 951 * initiated on our own). It indicates that 952 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 953 * after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's. The userspace may 954 * decide to react to this indication by requesting other 955 * interfaces to change channel as well. 956 * 957 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by 958 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with 959 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the 960 * P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and 961 * public action frame TX. 962 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by 963 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. 964 * 965 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to 966 * notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a 967 * station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON 968 * is used for this. 969 * 970 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames 971 * for IBSS or MESH vif. 972 * 973 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control. 974 * This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC 975 * address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in 976 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in 977 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it 978 * is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver 979 * will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This 980 * command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its 981 * ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP. 982 * 983 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once 984 * a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished 985 * or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with 986 * this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars 987 * while operating on this channel. 988 * %NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the 989 * event. 990 * 991 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features, 992 * i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features. 993 * Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap. 994 * 995 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition 996 * Information Element to the WLAN driver 997 * 998 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver 999 * to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along 1000 * with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report 1001 * received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE). 1002 * 1003 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running 1004 * a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to 1005 * complete. 1006 * 1007 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can 1008 * return back to normal. 1009 * 1010 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules. 1011 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules. 1012 * 1013 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the 1014 * new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA) 1015 * in the beacon for some time (as defined in the 1016 * %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the 1017 * new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using 1018 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel 1019 * width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform 1020 * other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel 1021 * switch is complete. 1022 * 1023 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified 1024 * by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in 1025 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in 1026 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 1027 * For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is 1028 * used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions 1029 * (&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands. 1030 * This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes. 1031 * 1032 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values. 1033 * The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If 1034 * that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this 1035 * QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an 1036 * association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart. 1037 * 1038 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given 1039 * %NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO 1040 * and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters. 1041 * Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by 1042 * userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets 1043 * up the TX TS in the driver/device. 1044 * If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks 1045 * if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to 1046 * avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would 1047 * make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still 1048 * fail even if the check was successful. 1049 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID 1050 * and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this 1051 * before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating 1052 * or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case. 1053 * 1054 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to 1055 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 1056 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 1057 * 1058 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and 1059 * bandwidth of a channel must be given. 1060 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the 1061 * network is determined by the network interface. 1062 * 1063 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer, 1064 * identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is 1065 * provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining 1066 * channel width/type. The target operating class is given via 1067 * %NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS. 1068 * The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching 1069 * operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the 1070 * AP. 1071 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS 1072 * peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel 1073 * when this command completes. 1074 * 1075 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used 1076 * as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom 1077 * management. 1078 * 1079 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is 1080 * not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through 1081 * cfg80211_scan_done(). 1082 * 1083 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its 1084 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been 1085 * previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it 1086 * has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a 1087 * cluster. This command must have a valid 1088 * %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional 1089 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is 1090 * omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will 1091 * decide what to use. After this command NAN functions can be 1092 * added. 1093 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by 1094 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. 1095 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined 1096 * with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this 1097 * operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id 1098 * (%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 1099 * of the function upon success. 1100 * Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right 1101 * way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination 1102 * event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new 1103 * function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one 1104 * which just terminated. 1105 * This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command 1106 * returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes 1107 * the response to this command. 1108 * Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well. 1109 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie. 1110 * This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is 1111 * terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID 1112 * and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes. 1113 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN 1114 * configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN 1115 * was executed). It must contain at least one of the following 1116 * attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 1117 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the 1118 * current configuration is not changed. If it is present but 1119 * set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care 1120 * (i.e. the device can decide what to do). 1121 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported. 1122 * This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and 1123 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE. 1124 * 1125 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters 1126 * for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal 1127 * BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it 1128 * does not result in a change for the current association. Currently, 1129 * only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command. 1130 * 1131 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0 1132 * for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1133 * When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the 1134 * PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK. 1135 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously 1136 * configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by 1137 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 1138 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was 1139 * completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload 1140 * should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with 1141 * %NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT 1142 * should be indicated instead. 1143 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request 1144 * and RX notification. This command is used both as a request to transmit 1145 * a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame 1146 * has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 1147 * frame contents. The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or 1148 * 802.11 headers. 1149 * For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and 1150 * its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known 1151 * to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit 1152 * the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both 1153 * the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link 1154 * address of that link. 1155 * When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 1156 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added 1157 * indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame 1158 * was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively. 1159 * 1160 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded. 1161 * 1162 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host 1163 * drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and 1164 * association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen. 1165 * This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space) 1166 * to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to 1167 * driver) to indicate the authentication status. 1168 * 1169 * User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to 1170 * trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses 1171 * this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user 1172 * space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user 1173 * space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds 1174 * further with the association after getting successful authentication 1175 * status. User space indicates the authentication status through 1176 * %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH 1177 * command interface. 1178 * 1179 * Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in 1180 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO 1181 * during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD 1182 * APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability 1183 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling 1184 * MLO during the authentication offload or not. 1185 * User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it 1186 * receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User 1187 * space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request 1188 * doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable. 1189 * User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and 1190 * interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD 1191 * address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and 1192 * BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the 1193 * MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the 1194 * authentication. 1195 * 1196 * Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the 1197 * user space through the connect result as the user space would have 1198 * initiated the connection through the connect request. 1199 * 1200 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's 1201 * ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 1202 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its 1203 * address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1204 * 1205 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in 1206 * the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute. 1207 * 1208 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s) 1209 * with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested 1210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address 1211 * randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the 1212 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes. 1213 * If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute. 1214 * A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in 1215 * the netlink extended ack message. 1216 * 1217 * To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it. 1218 * 1219 * Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the 1220 * measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they 1221 * become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket 1222 * buffer size. 1223 * 1224 * Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start 1225 * multiple concurrent measurements. 1226 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the 1227 * result notification from the driver to the requesting socket. 1228 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that 1229 * the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie 1230 * (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE). 1231 * 1232 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was 1233 * detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel 1234 * indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes 1235 * determining the width and type. 1236 * 1237 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to 1238 * offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support 1239 * OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely 1240 * on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode. 1241 * 1242 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric 1243 * refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data 1244 * frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a 1245 * primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of 1246 * the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some 1247 * form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be 1248 * properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the 1249 * regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data 1250 * so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for 1251 * rate selection. 1252 * 1253 * Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh 1254 * peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame 1255 * content. The frame is ethernet data. 1256 * 1257 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration 1258 * is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute. 1259 * 1260 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon 1261 * frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was 1262 * dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon 1263 * protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 1264 * 1265 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control 1266 * port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. 1267 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 1268 * includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included 1269 * if the recipient acknowledged the frame. 1270 * 1271 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is 1272 * passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to 1273 * specify the wiphy index to be applied to. 1274 * 1275 * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever 1276 * mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision. 1277 * 1278 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that 1279 * userspace wants to change the BSS color. 1280 * 1281 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has 1282 * started 1283 * 1284 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has 1285 * been aborted 1286 * 1287 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change 1288 * has completed 1289 * 1290 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using - 1291 * &NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address 1292 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK 1293 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces 1294 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 1295 * 1296 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association 1297 * temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 1298 * to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to 1299 * specify the timeout value. 1300 * 1301 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The 1302 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link. 1303 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come 1304 * without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links 1305 * in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP. 1306 * 1307 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station 1308 * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station 1309 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station 1310 * 1311 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing 1312 * measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 1313 * is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the 1314 * specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for 1315 * all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC 1316 * address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable 1317 * HW timestamping. 1318 * The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently 1319 * is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS. 1320 * 1321 * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD 1322 * setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with 1323 * Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide 1324 * information about the removed STA MLD setup links. 1325 * 1326 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number 1327 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use 1328 */ 1329 enum nl80211_commands { 1330 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 1331 NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC, 1332 1333 NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, /* can dump */ 1334 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY, 1335 NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY, 1336 NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY, 1337 1338 NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE, /* can dump */ 1339 NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE, 1340 NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE, 1341 NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE, 1342 1343 NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY, 1344 NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY, 1345 NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY, 1346 NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY, 1347 1348 NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON, 1349 NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, 1350 NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1351 NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1352 NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1353 NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1354 1355 NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, 1356 NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION, 1357 NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, 1358 NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION, 1359 1360 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, 1361 NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH, 1362 NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH, 1363 NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH, 1364 1365 NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS, 1366 1367 NL80211_CMD_SET_REG, 1368 NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG, 1369 1370 NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG, 1371 NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG, 1372 1373 NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */, 1374 1375 NL80211_CMD_GET_REG, 1376 1377 NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN, 1378 NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 1379 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS, 1380 NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED, 1381 1382 NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, 1383 1384 NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, 1385 NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 1386 NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1387 NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, 1388 1389 NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE, 1390 1391 NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT, 1392 1393 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS, 1394 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS, 1395 1396 NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 1397 1398 NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, 1399 NL80211_CMD_ROAM, 1400 NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT, 1401 1402 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS, 1403 1404 NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, 1405 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS, 1406 1407 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA, 1408 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA, 1409 NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA, 1410 1411 NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1412 NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1413 1414 NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK, 1415 1416 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1417 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1418 NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1419 NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1420 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1421 NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1422 1423 NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE, 1424 NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE, 1425 1426 NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM, 1427 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM, 1428 1429 NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL, 1430 NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER, 1431 1432 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL, 1433 1434 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH, 1435 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH, 1436 1437 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1438 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE, 1439 1440 NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE, 1441 1442 NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN, 1443 NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN, 1444 1445 NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN, 1446 NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN, 1447 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS, 1448 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED, 1449 1450 NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD, 1451 1452 NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 1453 1454 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER, 1455 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT, 1456 1457 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME, 1458 1459 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT, 1460 1461 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS, 1462 1463 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME, 1464 1465 NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP, 1466 1467 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY, 1468 1469 NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE, 1470 NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE, 1471 1472 NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED, 1473 1474 NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE, 1475 1476 NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, 1477 1478 NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT, 1479 1480 NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 1481 1482 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES, 1483 NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT, 1484 1485 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START, 1486 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP, 1487 1488 NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE, 1489 NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE, 1490 1491 NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1492 1493 NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 1494 1495 NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP, 1496 1497 NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS, 1498 NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS, 1499 1500 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP, 1501 1502 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB, 1503 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB, 1504 1505 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY, 1506 1507 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1508 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1509 1510 NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE, 1511 1512 NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN, 1513 1514 NL80211_CMD_START_NAN, 1515 NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN, 1516 NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION, 1517 NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION, 1518 NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, 1519 NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH, 1520 1521 NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST, 1522 1523 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS, 1524 1525 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK, 1526 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK, 1527 1528 NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 1529 1530 NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB, 1531 1532 NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH, 1533 1534 NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED, 1535 1536 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME, 1537 1538 NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 1539 1540 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START, 1541 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT, 1542 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE, 1543 1544 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR, 1545 1546 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO, 1547 1548 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK, 1549 1550 NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG, 1551 1552 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON, 1553 1554 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1555 1556 NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS, 1557 1558 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 1559 1560 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST, 1561 1562 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 1563 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 1564 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 1565 1566 NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD, 1567 1568 NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK, 1569 1570 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK, 1571 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK, 1572 1573 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA, 1574 NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA, 1575 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA, 1576 1577 NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP, 1578 1579 NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED, 1580 #ifdef CONFIG_MLD_PATCH 1581 NL80211_CMD_LINK_SWITCH_EVENT, 1582 #endif 1583 NL80211_CMD_MLO_WORK_STATE_EVENT, 1584 /* add new commands above here */ 1585 1586 /* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */ 1587 __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST, 1588 NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1 1589 }; 1590 1591 /* 1592 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them 1593 * here 1594 */ 1595 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS 1596 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE 1597 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE 1598 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE 1599 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1600 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE 1601 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE 1602 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT 1603 1604 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 1605 1606 /* source-level API compatibility */ 1607 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG 1608 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG 1609 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE 1610 1611 /** 1612 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes 1613 * 1614 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors 1615 * 1616 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf. 1617 * /sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index 1618 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming) 1619 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters 1620 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz, 1621 * defines the channel together with the (deprecated) 1622 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes 1623 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 1624 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 1625 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values 1626 * of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the 1627 * documentation of the enum for more information. 1628 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the 1629 * channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the 1630 * operating channel center frequency. 1631 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the 1632 * channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth 1633 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 1634 * if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included): 1635 * NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including 1636 * this attribute) 1637 * NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only 1638 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel 1639 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel 1640 * This attribute is now deprecated. 1641 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1642 * less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1643 * dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8 1644 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1645 * greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1646 * dot11ShortLongLimit; u8 1647 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum 1648 * length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable 1649 * fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32 1650 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length 1651 * larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range: 1652 * 0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32 1653 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11 1654 * section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8 1655 * 1656 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on 1657 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name 1658 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype 1659 * 1660 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices 1661 * that don't have a netdev (u64) 1662 * 1663 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses) 1664 * 1665 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 1666 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 1667 * keys 1668 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 1669 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 1670 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 1671 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 1672 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 1673 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key 1674 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the 1675 * default management key 1676 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or 1677 * other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used 1678 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or 1679 * other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used 1680 * 1681 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU 1682 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing 1683 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE 1684 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE 1685 * 1686 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16) 1687 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1688 * &enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2) 1689 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by 1690 * IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16). 1691 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported 1692 * rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1693 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1694 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station 1695 * to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to. 1696 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info 1697 * given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing 1698 * info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info. 1699 * 1700 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands, 1701 * consisting of a nested array. 1702 * 1703 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes). 1704 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link 1705 * (see &enum nl80211_plink_action). 1706 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path. 1707 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path 1708 * info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at 1709 * &enum nl80211_mpath_info. 1710 * 1711 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1712 * &enum nl80211_mntr_flags. 1713 * 1714 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the 1715 * current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to. 1716 * For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel 1717 * to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can 1718 * also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set 1719 * regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the 1720 * IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country. 1721 * Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain 1722 * to a specific alpha2. 1723 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory 1724 * rules. 1725 * 1726 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1) 1727 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1728 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1729 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled 1730 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1731 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic 1732 * rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1733 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1734 * 1735 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from 1736 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 1737 * 1738 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all 1739 * supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number 1740 * of the interface mode. 1741 * 1742 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for 1743 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE. 1744 * 1745 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with 1746 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE). 1747 * 1748 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with 1749 * a single scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1750 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can 1751 * scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1752 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements 1753 * that can be added to a scan request 1754 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information 1755 * elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request 1756 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be 1757 * used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute. 1758 * 1759 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz) 1760 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive 1761 * scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan 1762 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS 1763 * 1764 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain 1765 * currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_* 1766 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently 1767 * set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*) 1768 * 1769 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies 1770 * an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number) 1771 * that the driver for the given wiphy supports. 1772 * 1773 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header 1774 * and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and 1775 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events 1776 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets) 1777 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type, 1778 * represented as a u32 1779 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and 1780 * %NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16 1781 * 1782 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as 1783 * a u32 1784 * 1785 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1786 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1787 * the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This 1788 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1789 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1790 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1791 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1792 * the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This 1793 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1794 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1795 * 1796 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported 1797 * cipher suites 1798 * 1799 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look 1800 * for other networks on different channels 1801 * 1802 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this 1803 * is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event 1804 * 1805 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is 1806 * used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32); 1807 * this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 1808 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for 1809 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it 1810 * must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not. 1811 * Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will 1812 * let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not. 1813 * 1814 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a 1815 * &struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 1816 * 1817 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls 1818 * IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in 1819 * station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1820 * request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until 1821 * authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by 1822 * default in station mode. 1823 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the 1824 * ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be 1825 * specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not 1826 * specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This 1827 * attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to 1828 * indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported. 1829 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with 1830 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom 1831 * ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted. 1832 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control 1833 * port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE) 1834 * will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211 1835 * socket. If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending 1836 * control port frames directly to the network interface is used. If the 1837 * flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead 1838 * using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. If control port routing over NL80211 is 1839 * to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 1840 * flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth 1841 * frames are not forwared over the control port. 1842 * 1843 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver. 1844 * We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this. 1845 * 1846 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT 1847 * event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to 1848 * a local disconnect request. 1849 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 1850 * event (u16) 1851 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating 1852 * that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to 1853 * indicate that the BSS is to use protection. 1854 * 1855 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON 1856 * to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection 1857 * (an array of u32). 1858 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1859 * indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a 1860 * u32). 1861 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1862 * indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using 1863 * (a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions). 1864 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1865 * indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32). 1866 * This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, 1867 * indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which 1868 * implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also 1869 * the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware. 1870 * If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should 1871 * assume the driver supports all the AKM suites. 1872 * 1873 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as 1874 * sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1875 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as 1876 * sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1877 * 1878 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT 1879 * commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use 1880 * Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the 1881 * Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is 1882 * used for the initial association to an ESS. 1883 * 1884 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with 1885 * %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1886 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect() 1887 * and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each 1888 * with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1889 * 1890 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace. 1891 * 1892 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for 1893 * dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being 1894 * dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has 1895 * obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that 1896 * all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it 1897 * changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated 1898 * completely from scratch. 1899 * 1900 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface 1901 * 1902 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of 1903 * the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute 1904 * containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info. 1905 * 1906 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching. 1907 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can 1908 * cache, a wiphy attribute. 1909 * 1910 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32. 1911 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that 1912 * specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the 1913 * remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32. 1914 * 1915 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects. 1916 * 1917 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes 1918 * (enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The 1919 * enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested 1920 * data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all 1921 * rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute 1922 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP, 1923 * and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must 1924 * specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon. 1925 * The driver must also specify support for this with the extended 1926 * features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 1927 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 1928 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and 1929 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE. 1930 * 1931 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain 1932 * at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME. 1933 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the 1934 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command. 1935 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1936 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1937 * information about which frame types can be transmitted with 1938 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 1939 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1940 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1941 * information about which frame types can be registered for RX. 1942 * 1943 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was 1944 * acknowledged by the recipient. 1945 * 1946 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values. 1947 * 1948 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a 1949 * nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes. 1950 * 1951 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command 1952 * is requesting a local authentication/association state change without 1953 * invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with 1954 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1955 * NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 1956 * 1957 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations 1958 * connected to this BSS. 1959 * 1960 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See 1961 * &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values. 1962 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units. 1963 * This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING 1964 * for non-automatic settings. 1965 * 1966 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly 1967 * means support for per-station GTKs. 1968 * 1969 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting. 1970 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1971 * not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this 1972 * bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna. 1973 * 1974 * Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first 1975 * bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n 1976 * drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to 1977 * a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if 1978 * a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not. 1979 * HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be 1980 * derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask. 1981 * Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not. 1982 * Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot 1983 * support by returning -EINVAL. 1984 * 1985 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving. 1986 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1987 * not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap 1988 * the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna. 1989 * For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX. 1990 * 1991 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1992 * for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters. 1993 * 1994 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1995 * for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters. 1996 * 1997 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS 1998 * 1999 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be 2000 * transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match 2001 * the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this 2002 * flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an 2003 * nl80211 capability flag. 2004 * 2005 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16) 2006 * 2007 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 2008 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 2009 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 2010 * 2011 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters. These cannot be 2012 * changed once the mesh is active. 2013 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute 2014 * containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params. 2015 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver 2016 * allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via 2017 * the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag. 2018 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in 2019 * &enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link 2020 * management state machine. @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or 2021 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled. 2022 * 2023 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy 2024 * capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers 2025 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to 2026 * indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also 2027 * used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN 2028 * triggers. 2029 * 2030 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan 2031 * cycles, in msecs. 2032 * 2033 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more 2034 * sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans. Only BSSs 2035 * that match any of the sets will be reported. These are 2036 * pass-thru filter rules. 2037 * For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a 2038 * set. Since not every hardware supports matching all types of 2039 * attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are 2040 * fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be 2041 * able to ignore them by itself. 2042 * Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but 2043 * this is only an optimization and the userspace application 2044 * needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway. 2045 * If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with 2046 * the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID 2047 * is included in the probe request, but the match attributes 2048 * will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned. 2049 * If omitted, no filtering is done. 2050 * 2051 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported 2052 * interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes 2053 * defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 2054 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like 2055 * %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that 2056 * are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to 2057 * any restrictions in their number or combinations. 2058 * 2059 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information 2060 * necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data. 2061 * 2062 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan, 2063 * nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry 2064 * being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but 2065 * without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 2066 * 2067 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon 2068 * and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see 2069 * &enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32 2070 * 2071 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame. 2072 * This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to 2073 * provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the 2074 * driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames. 2075 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association 2076 * Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and 2077 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into 2078 * (Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to 2079 * (Re)Association Request frames. 2080 * 2081 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration 2082 * of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr. 2083 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working 2084 * as AP. 2085 * 2086 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of 2087 * roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low. 2088 * 2089 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching 2090 * candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr. 2091 * 2092 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not 2093 * for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action 2094 * frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space 2095 * applications use this attribute. 2096 * This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and 2097 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands. 2098 * 2099 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup 2100 * request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are 2101 * described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification. 2102 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a 2103 * TDLS conversation between two devices. 2104 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see 2105 * &enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8. 2106 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate 2107 * as a TDLS peer sta. 2108 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown 2109 * procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via 2110 * %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 2111 * used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation. 2112 * 2113 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices 2114 * that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated 2115 * with support for the features listed in this attribute, see 2116 * &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 2117 * 2118 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells 2119 * the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this, 2120 * it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is 2121 * mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime. 2122 * 2123 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from 2124 * &enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information. 2125 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe 2126 * requests while operating in AP-mode. 2127 * This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for 2128 * offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr). 2129 * 2130 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire 2131 * probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out, 2132 * to be filled by the FW. 2133 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable 2134 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2135 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2136 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable 2137 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2138 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2139 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable 2140 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2141 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2142 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the 2143 * ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid. 2144 * Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature. 2145 * The values that may be configured are: 2146 * MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40 2147 * AMPDU density and AMPDU factor. 2148 * All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored 2149 * by the driver as required. The actual values may be seen in 2150 * the station debugfs ht_caps file. 2151 * 2152 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country 2153 * abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps 2154 * to one DFS region. 2155 * 2156 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of 2157 * up to 16 TIDs. 2158 * 2159 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be 2160 * used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support 2161 * to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from 2162 * the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the 2163 * capability to timeout the stations. 2164 * 2165 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int); 2166 * this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to 2167 * received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 2168 * 2169 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds 2170 * or 0 to disable background scan. 2171 * 2172 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from 2173 * userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from 2174 * a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source 2175 * was used to provide the hint. For the different types of 2176 * allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type. 2177 * 2178 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected 2179 * the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason 2180 * enum has different reasons of connection failure. 2181 * 2182 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. 2183 * This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), 2184 * excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the 2185 * Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with 2186 * authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into 2187 * the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the 2188 * initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and 2189 * Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data 2190 * for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition 2191 * consistent. 2192 * 2193 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from 2194 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2195 * 2196 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32) 2197 * 2198 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with 2199 * the START_AP and SET_BSS commands 2200 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the 2201 * START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1; 2202 * if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS 2203 * no change is made. 2204 * 2205 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 2206 * defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode. 2207 * 2208 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy, 2209 * carried in a u32 attribute 2210 * 2211 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for 2212 * MAC ACL. 2213 * 2214 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum 2215 * number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC 2216 * ACL. 2217 * 2218 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace, 2219 * contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32). 2220 * 2221 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2222 * has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See 2223 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information. 2224 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2225 * has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields. 2226 * 2227 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to 2228 * the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD). 2229 * 2230 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are 2231 * advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations 2232 * and PU-APSD. 2233 * 2234 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see 2235 * &enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32. 2236 * 2237 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports 2238 * receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple 2239 * messages, given with wiphy dump message 2240 * 2241 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier 2242 * 2243 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information 2244 * Element 2245 * 2246 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased 2247 * reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16). 2248 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which 2249 * the connection should have increased reliability (u16). 2250 * 2251 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16). 2252 * This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being 2253 * allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to 2254 * update a TDLS peer STA entry. 2255 * 2256 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information. 2257 * 2258 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2259 * until the channel switch event. 2260 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission 2261 * must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch 2262 * operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet 2263 * was requested by the AP. 2264 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information 2265 * for the time while performing a channel switch. 2266 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2267 * switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL). 2268 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2269 * switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP). 2270 * 2271 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32. 2272 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags. 2273 * 2274 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels. 2275 * 2276 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported 2277 * operating classes. 2278 * 2279 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space 2280 * controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in 2281 * %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS 2282 * channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required 2283 * to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the 2284 * IBSS network. 2285 * 2286 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2287 * 5 MHz channel bandwidth. 2288 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2289 * 10 MHz channel bandwidth. 2290 * 2291 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode 2292 * Notification Element based on association request when used with 2293 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when 2294 * %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS); 2295 * u8 attribute. 2296 * 2297 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if 2298 * %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet) 2299 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command 2300 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this 2301 * attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement 2302 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy 2303 * info, containing a nested array of possible events 2304 * 2305 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This 2306 * data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element 2307 * in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97. 2308 * 2309 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS 2310 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS 2311 * 2312 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many 2313 * associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32. 2314 * Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g., 2315 * other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to 2316 * advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt 2317 * to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail. 2318 * 2319 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which 2320 * should be updated when the frame is transmitted. 2321 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum 2322 * supported number of csa counters. 2323 * 2324 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32. 2325 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability. 2326 * 2327 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface 2328 * creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket 2329 * that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed. 2330 * If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be 2331 * owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will 2332 * be stopped when the socket is closed. 2333 * If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the 2334 * regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket 2335 * that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be 2336 * cleared when the socket is closed. 2337 * If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed 2338 * if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN 2339 * notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this 2340 * attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN 2341 * multicast group. 2342 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the 2343 * station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed. 2344 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically 2345 * torn down when the socket is closed. 2346 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be 2347 * automatically torn down when the socket is closed. 2348 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically 2349 * disabled when the socket is closed. 2350 * 2351 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is 2352 * the TDLS link initiator. 2353 * 2354 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection 2355 * shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be 2356 * used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. 2357 * User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the 2358 * underlying device supports these minimal RRM features: 2359 * %NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES, 2360 * %NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET, 2361 * Or, if global RRM is supported, see: 2362 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM 2363 * If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the 2364 * association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability 2365 * flag in the association request's Capability Info field. 2366 * 2367 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout 2368 * estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack 2369 * %NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower 2370 * drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled 2371 * setting valid value for coverage class. 2372 * 2373 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute) 2374 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute) 2375 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds 2376 * (per second) (u16 attribute) 2377 * 2378 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see 2379 * &enum nl80211_smps_mode. 2380 * 2381 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class 2382 * 2383 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask 2384 * 2385 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device 2386 * is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain 2387 * obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global 2388 * cfg80211 regdomain. 2389 * 2390 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte 2391 * array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum 2392 * nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the 2393 * least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0 2394 * is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1 2395 * of byte 3 (u8 array). 2396 * 2397 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be 2398 * returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY 2399 * may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio 2400 * statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.) 2401 * For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information 2402 * should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters 2403 * over all channels. 2404 * 2405 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a 2406 * scheduled scan is started. Or the delay before a WoWLAN 2407 * net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the 2408 * system is suspended. This value is a u32, in seconds. 2409 2410 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device 2411 * is operating in an indoor environment. 2412 * 2413 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for 2414 * scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2415 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for 2416 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2417 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in 2418 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2419 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan. 2420 * Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval 2421 * between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely, 2422 * thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval 2423 * between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially. 2424 * Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan. 2425 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate 2426 * in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request 2427 * connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start 2428 * a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only. 2429 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the 2430 * BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains 2431 * attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what 2432 * BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 2433 * it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for 2434 * BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware. 2435 * 2436 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported 2437 * or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status 2438 * 2439 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 2440 * 2441 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes: 2442 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 2443 * %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and 2444 * other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO, 2445 * %NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are 2446 * present. 2447 * 2448 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO 2449 * groupID for monitor mode. 2450 * The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each 2451 * group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved), 2452 * each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in 2453 * that group and 0 for not being a member. 2454 * The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for 2455 * each group. 2456 * (smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger 2457 * group numbers on least significant bits.) 2458 * This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode. 2459 * Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO 2460 * groupID data. 2461 * to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero. 2462 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow 2463 * when using MU-MIMO air sniffer. 2464 * to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address 2465 * (e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF) 2466 * 2467 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually 2468 * started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that 2469 * requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this 2470 * attribute must not be included). 2471 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which 2472 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set. 2473 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If 2474 * %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the 2475 * maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with 2476 * measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN 2477 * if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement. 2478 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates 2479 * that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is 2480 * mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration 2481 * and the actual measurement duration may be shorter. 2482 * 2483 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is 2484 * used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state. 2485 * 2486 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by 2487 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with 2488 * %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0. 2489 * Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and 2490 * should not be used during a normal device operation. 2491 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration. This is a u32 2492 * bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum 2493 * nl80211_band. For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 2494 * would be set. This attribute is used with 2495 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and 2496 * it is optional. If no bands are set, it means don't-care and 2497 * the device will decide what to use. 2498 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See 2499 * &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested 2500 * attribute. 2501 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute. 2502 * See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes. 2503 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame 2504 * protection. 2505 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association 2506 * Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet 2507 * STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2508 * 2509 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast 2510 * packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute). 2511 * 2512 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also 2513 * used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID. 2514 * 2515 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which 2516 * other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current 2517 * connected BSS so that they get reported to user space. 2518 * This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to 2519 * other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than 2520 * the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid 2521 * unnecessary wakeups. 2522 * 2523 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in 2524 * the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 2525 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out 2526 * better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure 2527 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 2528 * 2529 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out. 2530 * u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used, 2531 * e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event. 2532 * 2533 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) 2534 * username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with 2535 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2536 * 2537 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part 2538 * of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with 2539 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2540 * 2541 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number 2542 * to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data 2543 * for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2544 * 2545 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the 2546 * NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and 2547 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK 2548 * from successful FILS authentication and is used with 2549 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2550 * 2551 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP 2552 * identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with 2553 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA. 2554 * 2555 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with 2556 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID. 2557 * For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide 2558 * PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X 2559 * authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT 2560 * support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME 2561 * is included as well. 2562 * 2563 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to 2564 * indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests. 2565 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled 2566 * scan request that may be active for the device (u32). 2567 * 2568 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include 2569 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it 2570 * wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake. 2571 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT. 2572 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved) 2573 * 2574 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external 2575 * authentication operation (u32 attribute with an 2576 * &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the 2577 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event. 2578 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user 2579 * space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used 2580 * with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver 2581 * may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability 2582 * is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag 2583 * attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use 2584 * %NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS) 2585 * 2586 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated RX_NSS value notified using this 2587 * u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED. 2588 * 2589 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum 2590 * nl80211_txq_stats) 2591 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy. 2592 * The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced. 2593 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the 2594 * TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is 2595 * enforced. 2596 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes 2597 * a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler. 2598 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from 2599 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2600 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2601 * 2602 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include 2603 * in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing 2604 * measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as 2605 * possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr 2606 * 2607 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder 2608 * statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats. 2609 * 2610 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32), 2611 * if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an 2612 * invalid value. 2613 * 2614 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result) 2615 * data, uses nested attributes specified in 2616 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs. 2617 * This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information, 2618 * with the appropriate sub-attributes. 2619 * 2620 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime 2621 * scheduler. 2622 * 2623 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for 2624 * station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for 2625 * possible values. 2626 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This 2627 * allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included, 2628 * the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver 2629 * should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface 2630 * or per-station. 2631 * 2632 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It 2633 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading 2634 * SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks. 2635 * 2636 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support. 2637 * 2638 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection 2639 * functionality. 2640 * 2641 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 2642 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 2643 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute) 2644 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 2645 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute) 2646 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 2647 * 2648 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key 2649 * (u16). 2650 * 2651 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings. 2652 * 2653 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry 2654 * using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This 2655 * attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating 2656 * supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in 2657 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not 2658 * advertised for a specific interface type. 2659 * 2660 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a 2661 * nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes; 2662 * on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub- 2663 * attributes. 2664 * 2665 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control 2666 * port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames. 2667 * 2668 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32, 2669 * dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value). 2670 * An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. 2671 * Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the 2672 * configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based 2673 * authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE, 2674 * where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE) 2675 * authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP 2676 * authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall 2677 * result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime. 2678 * 2679 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in 2680 * terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME 2681 * (u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional 2682 * parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the 2683 * driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching) 2684 * after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime 2685 * has expired. 2686 * 2687 * Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA 2688 * entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If 2689 * no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration, 2690 * disassociation is still forced. 2691 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the 2692 * %NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there. 2693 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated 2694 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with 2695 * an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET. 2696 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the 2697 * first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1. 2698 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies 2699 * 2700 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from 2701 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). 2702 * 2703 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS 2704 * discovery. It is a nested attribute, see 2705 * &enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty 2706 * nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates. 2707 * 2708 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure 2709 * unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see 2710 * &enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty 2711 * nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates. 2712 * 2713 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from 2714 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2715 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element 2716 * override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in 2717 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2718 * 2719 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 2720 * derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication. 2721 * This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from 2722 * &enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism. 2723 * 2724 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when 2725 * used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields 2726 * of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related 2727 * sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 2728 * 2729 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and 2730 * disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP 2731 * is desired. 2732 * 2733 * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the 2734 * %NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event. 2735 * 2736 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2737 * until the color switch event. 2738 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are 2739 * switching to 2740 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE 2741 * information for the time while performing a color switch. 2742 * 2743 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID 2744 * advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode. 2745 * Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID 2746 * and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace. 2747 * Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID 2748 * parameters. 2749 * See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details. 2750 * 2751 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements. 2752 * Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID. 2753 * Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces. 2754 * 2755 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain 2756 * available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used 2757 * to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 2758 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 2759 * switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 2760 * radar channel. 2761 * 2762 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags, 2763 * enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be 2764 * used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. 2765 * 2766 * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from 2767 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2768 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2769 * 2770 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with 2771 * various commands that need a link ID to operate. 2772 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some 2773 * per-link information and a link ID. 2774 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as 2775 * authenticate/associate. 2776 * 2777 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO 2778 * connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not 2779 * included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection. 2780 * 2781 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of 2782 * AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 2783 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this 2784 * attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM 2785 * suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum 2786 * number prior to the introduction of this attribute. 2787 * 2788 * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16) 2789 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16) 2790 * 2791 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in 2792 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2793 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2794 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX 2795 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2796 * the ack TX timestamp. 2797 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in 2798 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2799 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2800 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX 2801 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2802 * the incoming frame RX timestamp. 2803 * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent 2804 * (re)associations. 2805 * 2806 * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest 2807 * bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1 2808 * indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are 2809 * reserved. 2810 * 2811 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW 2812 * timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute. 2813 * A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying 2814 * an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported. 2815 * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should 2816 * be enabled or not (flag attribute). 2817 * 2818 * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for 2819 * reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used 2820 * only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled. 2821 * Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple 2822 * elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting 2823 * profiles already included in the MBSSID element 2824 * (%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon 2825 * will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same 2826 * index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of 2827 * MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon. 2828 * 2829 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is 2830 * disabled. 2831 * 2832 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available 2833 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined 2834 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2835 */ 2836 enum nl80211_attrs { 2837 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 2838 NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC, 2839 2840 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, 2841 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 2842 2843 NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 2844 NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME, 2845 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, 2846 2847 NL80211_ATTR_MAC, 2848 2849 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 2850 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, 2851 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 2852 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ, 2853 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 2854 2855 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 2856 NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, 2857 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD, 2858 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL, 2859 2860 NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID, 2861 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS, 2862 NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL, 2863 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES, 2864 NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN, 2865 NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO, 2866 2867 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS, 2868 2869 NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS, 2870 2871 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID, 2872 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION, 2873 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP, 2874 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO, 2875 2876 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT, 2877 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2878 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 2879 2880 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY, 2881 2882 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES, 2883 2884 NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2, 2885 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES, 2886 2887 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG, 2888 2889 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES, 2890 2891 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, 2892 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 2893 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE, 2894 2895 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 2896 2897 NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE, 2898 NL80211_ATTR_IE, 2899 2900 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS, 2901 2902 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 2903 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS, 2904 NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */ 2905 NL80211_ATTR_BSS, 2906 2907 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR, 2908 NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE, 2909 2910 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS, 2911 2912 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME, 2913 NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 2914 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 2915 NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE, 2916 2917 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE, 2918 2919 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2920 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES, 2921 2922 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE, 2923 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER, 2924 2925 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED, 2926 2927 2928 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, 2929 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 2930 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, 2931 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD, 2932 2933 NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT, 2934 2935 NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, 2936 2937 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2, 2938 2939 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 2940 2941 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 2942 2943 NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 2944 2945 NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP, 2946 NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE, 2947 2948 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE, 2949 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, 2950 NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 2951 NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, 2952 2953 NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE, 2954 NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE, 2955 2956 NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID, 2957 2958 NL80211_ATTR_KEY, 2959 NL80211_ATTR_KEYS, 2960 2961 NL80211_ATTR_PID, 2962 2963 NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR, 2964 2965 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO, 2966 2967 NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, 2968 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS, 2969 2970 NL80211_ATTR_DURATION, 2971 2972 NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE, 2973 2974 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS, 2975 2976 NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES, 2977 2978 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH, 2979 2980 NL80211_ATTR_ACK, 2981 2982 NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE, 2983 2984 NL80211_ATTR_CQM, 2985 2986 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE, 2987 2988 NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE, 2989 2990 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING, 2991 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL, 2992 2993 NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES, 2994 NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES, 2995 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE, 2996 2997 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 2998 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 2999 3000 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN, 3001 3002 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX, 3003 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX, 3004 3005 NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE, 3006 3007 NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK, 3008 3009 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE, 3010 3011 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 3012 3013 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION, 3014 3015 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP, 3016 3017 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX, 3018 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX, 3019 3020 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH, 3021 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE, 3022 3023 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS, 3024 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, 3025 3026 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL, 3027 3028 NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS, 3029 NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES, 3030 3031 NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA, 3032 3033 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS, 3034 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN, 3035 3036 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES, 3037 3038 NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, 3039 3040 NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP, 3041 NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP, 3042 3043 NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME, 3044 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD, 3045 3046 NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT, 3047 3048 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, 3049 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS, 3050 3051 NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 3052 3053 NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE, 3054 3055 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION, 3056 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN, 3057 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION, 3058 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT, 3059 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP, 3060 3061 NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME, 3062 3063 NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK, 3064 3065 NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS, 3066 3067 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD, 3068 3069 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP, 3070 3071 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION, 3072 3073 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT, 3074 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3075 3076 NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP, 3077 3078 NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 3079 3080 NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM, 3081 3082 NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 3083 3084 NL80211_ATTR_WDEV, 3085 3086 NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE, 3087 3088 NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON, 3089 3090 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA, 3091 3092 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY, 3093 3094 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS, 3095 3096 NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH, 3097 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1, 3098 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2, 3099 3100 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW, 3101 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS, 3102 3103 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE, 3104 3105 NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY, 3106 3107 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS, 3108 3109 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX, 3110 3111 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT, 3112 3113 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 3114 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, 3115 3116 NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY, 3117 NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY, 3118 3119 NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 3120 NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP, 3121 3122 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT, 3123 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3124 3125 NL80211_ATTR_MDID, 3126 NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC, 3127 3128 NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID, 3129 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION, 3130 3131 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID, 3132 3133 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 3134 3135 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT, 3136 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX, 3137 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES, 3138 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON, 3139 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP, 3140 3141 NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS, 3142 3143 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS, 3144 3145 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES, 3146 3147 NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS, 3148 3149 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ, 3150 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ, 3151 3152 NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF, 3153 3154 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID, 3155 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD, 3156 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 3157 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS, 3158 3159 NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP, 3160 3161 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, 3162 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT, 3163 3164 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA, 3165 3166 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY, 3167 3168 NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER, 3169 3170 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX, 3171 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS, 3172 3173 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR, 3174 3175 NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM, 3176 3177 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK, 3178 3179 NL80211_ATTR_TSID, 3180 NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO, 3181 NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME, 3182 3183 NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 3184 3185 NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS, 3186 3187 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK, 3188 3189 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG, 3190 3191 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES, 3192 3193 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS, 3194 3195 NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD, 3196 3197 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY, 3198 3199 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR, 3200 3201 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3202 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 3203 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 3204 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3205 3206 NL80211_ATTR_PBSS, 3207 3208 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT, 3209 3210 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS, 3211 3212 NL80211_ATTR_PAD, 3213 3214 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA, 3215 3216 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA, 3217 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR, 3218 3219 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF, 3220 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID, 3221 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION, 3222 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY, 3223 3224 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID, 3225 3226 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 3227 NL80211_ATTR_BANDS, 3228 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC, 3229 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH, 3230 3231 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK, 3232 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES, 3233 3234 NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED, 3235 3236 NL80211_ATTR_BSSID, 3237 3238 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 3239 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST, 3240 3241 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON, 3242 3243 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME, 3244 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM, 3245 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM, 3246 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK, 3247 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 3248 3249 NL80211_ATTR_PMK, 3250 3251 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI, 3252 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS, 3253 3254 NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS, 3255 NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME, 3256 NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 3257 3258 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION, 3259 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT, 3260 3261 NL80211_ATTR_NSS, 3262 NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL, 3263 3264 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 3265 3266 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS, 3267 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT, 3268 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT, 3269 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM, 3270 3271 NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY, 3272 3273 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER, 3274 3275 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 3276 3277 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT, 3278 3279 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS, 3280 3281 NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3282 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING, 3283 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER, 3284 3285 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD, 3286 3287 NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER, 3288 3289 NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD, 3290 3291 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS, 3292 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 3293 3294 NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID, 3295 3296 NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR, 3297 3298 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES, 3299 3300 NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG, 3301 3302 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 3303 3304 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME, 3305 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD, 3306 3307 NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST, 3308 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, 3309 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET, 3310 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 3311 3312 NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY, 3313 3314 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY, 3315 3316 NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 3317 3318 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY, 3319 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3320 3321 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE, 3322 3323 NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED, 3324 3325 NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC, 3326 3327 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE, 3328 3329 NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 3330 3331 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT, 3332 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR, 3333 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS, 3334 3335 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, 3336 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 3337 3338 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 3339 3340 NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS, 3341 3342 NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY, 3343 3344 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT, 3345 3346 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS, 3347 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID, 3348 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR, 3349 3350 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT, 3351 3352 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES, 3353 3354 NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY, 3355 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS, 3356 3357 NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3358 NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3359 NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP, 3360 3361 NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP, 3362 3363 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS, 3364 NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED, 3365 3366 NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS, 3367 3368 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED, 3369 #ifdef CONFIG_MLD_PATCH 3370 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_SWITCH_LINK_ID, 3371 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_SWITCH_WORK_BSSID, 3372 #endif 3373 NL80211_ATTR_COFEATURE, 3374 NL80211_ATTR_COFEATURE_STATE, 3375 NL80211_ATTR_COFEATURE_SWITCH_REASON, 3376 /* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */ 3377 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT = 351, 3378 #ifdef CONFIG_VENDOR_EXT 3379 NL80211_ATTR_FAST_CONNECT_FLAG, 3380 NL80211_ATTR_NO_ENCRPTY_FLAG, 3381 #endif 3382 __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3383 NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3384 NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3385 }; 3386 3387 /* source-level API compatibility */ 3388 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION 3389 #define NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG 3390 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 3391 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA 3392 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON 3393 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP 3394 3395 /* 3396 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them 3397 * here 3398 */ 3399 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 3400 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY 3401 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES 3402 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS 3403 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 3404 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE 3405 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE 3406 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE 3407 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR 3408 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE 3409 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 3410 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID 3411 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE 3412 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE 3413 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE 3414 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP 3415 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS 3416 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES 3417 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY 3418 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS 3419 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 3420 3421 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN 64 3422 3423 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES 32 3424 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES 77 3425 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES 128 3426 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY 0 3427 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY 16 3428 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY 24 3429 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN 26 3430 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN 12 3431 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 16 3432 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 54 3433 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES 5 3434 3435 /* 3436 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 3437 * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. 3438 */ 3439 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES 2 3440 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 13 3441 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 51 3442 3443 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME 10 3444 3445 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */ 3446 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF -300 3447 3448 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL 1800 3449 3450 /** 3451 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types 3452 * 3453 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides 3454 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member 3455 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member 3456 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point 3457 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces 3458 * are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing 3459 * AP type interface. 3460 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface 3461 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames 3462 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point 3463 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client 3464 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner 3465 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev 3466 * and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the 3467 * %NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE 3468 * commands to create and destroy one 3469 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS 3470 * This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true 3471 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev) 3472 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined 3473 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types 3474 * 3475 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE 3476 * to set the type of an interface. 3477 * 3478 */ 3479 enum nl80211_iftype { 3480 NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED, 3481 NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC, 3482 NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION, 3483 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP, 3484 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN, 3485 NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS, 3486 NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR, 3487 NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT, 3488 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT, 3489 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO, 3490 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE, 3491 NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB, 3492 NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN, 3493 3494 /* keep last */ 3495 NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES, 3496 NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1 3497 }; 3498 3499 /** 3500 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags 3501 * 3502 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is 3503 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.) 3504 * 3505 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3506 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 3507 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames 3508 * with short barker preamble 3509 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable 3510 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection 3511 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated 3512 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should 3513 * only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the 3514 * flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and 3515 * attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected 3516 * as errors.) 3517 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers 3518 * that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a 3519 * previously added station into associated state 3520 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined 3521 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3522 */ 3523 enum nl80211_sta_flags { 3524 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID, 3525 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, 3526 NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3527 NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME, 3528 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP, 3529 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED, 3530 NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER, 3531 NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED, 3532 3533 /* keep last */ 3534 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 3535 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 3536 }; 3537 3538 /** 3539 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS 3540 * 3541 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism 3542 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism 3543 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values 3544 */ 3545 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status { 3546 NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0, 3547 NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED, 3548 3549 NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS, 3550 }; 3551 3552 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER 3553 3554 /** 3555 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set 3556 * @mask: mask of station flags to set 3557 * @set: which values to set them to 3558 * 3559 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags. 3560 */ 3561 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update { 3562 __u32 mask; 3563 __u32 set; 3564 } __attribute__((packed)); 3565 3566 /** 3567 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval 3568 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3569 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3570 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3571 */ 3572 enum nl80211_he_gi { 3573 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8, 3574 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6, 3575 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2, 3576 }; 3577 3578 /** 3579 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field 3580 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec 3581 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec 3582 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec 3583 */ 3584 enum nl80211_he_ltf { 3585 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF, 3586 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF, 3587 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF, 3588 }; 3589 3590 /** 3591 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values 3592 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3593 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3594 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3595 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3596 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3597 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3598 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3599 */ 3600 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc { 3601 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26, 3602 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52, 3603 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106, 3604 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242, 3605 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484, 3606 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996, 3607 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3608 }; 3609 3610 /** 3611 * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval 3612 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3613 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3614 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3615 */ 3616 enum nl80211_eht_gi { 3617 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8, 3618 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6, 3619 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2, 3620 }; 3621 3622 /** 3623 * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values 3624 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3625 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3626 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation 3627 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3628 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation 3629 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3630 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3631 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation 3632 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3633 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation 3634 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation 3635 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3636 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation 3637 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation 3638 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation 3639 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation 3640 */ 3641 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc { 3642 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26, 3643 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52, 3644 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26, 3645 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106, 3646 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26, 3647 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242, 3648 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484, 3649 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242, 3650 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996, 3651 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484, 3652 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242, 3653 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3654 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484, 3655 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996, 3656 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484, 3657 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996, 3658 }; 3659 3660 /** 3661 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information 3662 * 3663 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE 3664 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3665 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents 3666 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value. 3667 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported 3668 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits 3669 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included. 3670 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall 3671 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels. 3672 * 3673 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3674 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s) 3675 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8) 3676 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate 3677 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 3678 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s) 3679 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined 3680 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8) 3681 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8) 3682 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate 3683 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the 3684 * same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates 3685 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate 3686 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is 3687 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3688 * half the base (20 MHz) rate 3689 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is 3690 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3691 * a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate 3692 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11) 3693 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3694 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier 3695 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi) 3696 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1) 3697 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then 3698 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc) 3699 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate 3700 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15) 3701 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3702 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier 3703 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 3704 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then 3705 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc) 3706 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10) 3707 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4) 3708 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate 3709 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate 3710 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate 3711 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate 3712 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate 3713 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3714 */ 3715 enum nl80211_rate_info { 3716 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID, 3717 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE, 3718 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS, 3719 NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH, 3720 NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI, 3721 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32, 3722 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS, 3723 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS, 3724 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3725 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3726 NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH, 3727 NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH, 3728 NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH, 3729 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS, 3730 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS, 3731 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI, 3732 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM, 3733 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC, 3734 NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH, 3735 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS, 3736 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS, 3737 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI, 3738 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC, 3739 NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS, 3740 NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS, 3741 NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH, 3742 NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH, 3743 NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH, 3744 NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH, 3745 NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH, 3746 3747 /* keep last */ 3748 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3749 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3750 }; 3751 3752 /** 3753 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA 3754 * 3755 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM 3756 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3757 * 3758 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3759 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag) 3760 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 3761 * (flag) 3762 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 3763 * (flag) 3764 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8) 3765 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16) 3766 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined 3767 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3768 */ 3769 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param { 3770 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID, 3771 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT, 3772 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3773 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 3774 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD, 3775 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL, 3776 3777 /* keep last */ 3778 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST, 3779 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1 3780 }; 3781 3782 /** 3783 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information 3784 * 3785 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO 3786 * when getting information about a station. 3787 * 3788 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3789 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs) 3790 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3791 * (u32, from this station) 3792 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3793 * (u32, to this station) 3794 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3795 * (u64, from this station) 3796 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3797 * (u64, to this station) 3798 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm) 3799 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute 3800 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info 3801 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3802 * (u32, from this station) 3803 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3804 * (u32, to this station) 3805 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station) 3806 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs) 3807 * (u32, to this station) 3808 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm) 3809 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID 3810 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID 3811 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station 3812 * (see %enum nl80211_plink_state) 3813 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested 3814 * attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE. 3815 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute 3816 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param 3817 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected 3818 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 3819 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32) 3820 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64) 3821 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 3822 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode 3823 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards 3824 * non-peer STA 3825 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU 3826 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm) 3827 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average 3828 * Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL. 3829 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the 3830 * 802.11 header (u32, kbps) 3831 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons 3832 * (u64) 3833 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64) 3834 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average 3835 * for beacons only (u8, dBm) 3836 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats) 3837 * This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the 3838 * TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames; 3839 * each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats 3840 * attributes carrying the actual values. 3841 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3842 * received from the station (u64, usec) 3843 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3844 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm) 3845 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm) 3846 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs) 3847 * (u32, from this station) 3848 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received 3849 * with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include 3850 * some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter 3851 * might not be fully accurate. 3852 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a 3853 * mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1) 3854 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3855 * sent to the station (u64, usec) 3856 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16) 3857 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station 3858 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds) 3859 * of STA's association 3860 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a 3861 * authentication server (u8, 0 or 1) 3862 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal 3863 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute 3864 */ 3865 enum nl80211_sta_info { 3866 __NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID, 3867 NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME, 3868 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES, 3869 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES, 3870 NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID, 3871 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID, 3872 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE, 3873 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL, 3874 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE, 3875 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS, 3876 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS, 3877 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES, 3878 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED, 3879 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG, 3880 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE, 3881 NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM, 3882 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME, 3883 NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS, 3884 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS, 3885 NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET, 3886 NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM, 3887 NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM, 3888 NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM, 3889 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64, 3890 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64, 3891 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 3892 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG, 3893 NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT, 3894 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC, 3895 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX, 3896 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG, 3897 NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS, 3898 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION, 3899 NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD, 3900 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL, 3901 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG, 3902 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS, 3903 NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT, 3904 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 3905 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION, 3906 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3907 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC, 3908 NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME, 3909 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 3910 3911 /* keep last */ 3912 __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3913 NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3914 }; 3915 3916 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 3917 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG 3918 3919 3920 /** 3921 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes 3922 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3923 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64) 3924 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or 3925 * attempted to transmit; u64) 3926 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for 3927 * transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64) 3928 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted 3929 * MSDUs (u64) 3930 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3931 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute) 3932 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here 3933 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3934 */ 3935 enum nl80211_tid_stats { 3936 __NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID, 3937 NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU, 3938 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU, 3939 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES, 3940 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED, 3941 NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD, 3942 NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS, 3943 3944 /* keep last */ 3945 NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS, 3946 NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1 3947 }; 3948 3949 /** 3950 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes 3951 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3952 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here 3953 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged 3954 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently 3955 * backlogged 3956 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen 3957 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops 3958 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks 3959 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow 3960 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 3961 * (only for per-phy stats) 3962 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions 3963 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ 3964 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ 3965 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY 3966 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3967 */ 3968 enum nl80211_txq_stats { 3969 __NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID, 3970 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES, 3971 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS, 3972 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS, 3973 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS, 3974 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS, 3975 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT, 3976 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY, 3977 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS, 3978 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES, 3979 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS, 3980 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS, 3981 3982 /* keep last */ 3983 NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS, 3984 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1 3985 }; 3986 3987 /** 3988 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags 3989 * 3990 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active 3991 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running 3992 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN 3993 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set 3994 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded 3995 */ 3996 enum nl80211_mpath_flags { 3997 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<0, 3998 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING = 1<<1, 3999 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID = 1<<2, 4000 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED = 1<<3, 4001 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED = 1<<4, 4002 }; 4003 4004 /** 4005 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information 4006 * 4007 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting 4008 * information about a mesh path. 4009 * 4010 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4011 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination 4012 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number 4013 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path 4014 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now 4015 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in 4016 * &enum nl80211_mpath_flags; 4017 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec 4018 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries 4019 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination 4020 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination 4021 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number 4022 * currently defined 4023 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4024 */ 4025 enum nl80211_mpath_info { 4026 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID, 4027 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN, 4028 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN, 4029 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC, 4030 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME, 4031 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS, 4032 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 4033 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES, 4034 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT, 4035 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE, 4036 4037 /* keep last */ 4038 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 4039 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 4040 }; 4041 4042 /** 4043 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes 4044 * 4045 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4046 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute 4047 * for each interface type that supports the band data 4048 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE 4049 * capabilities IE 4050 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE 4051 * capabilities IE 4052 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE 4053 * capabilities IE 4054 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as 4055 * defined in HE capabilities IE 4056 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16), 4057 * given for all 6 GHz band channels 4058 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are 4059 * advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary) 4060 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT 4061 * capabilities element 4062 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT 4063 * capabilities element 4064 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT 4065 * capabilities element 4066 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as 4067 * defined in EHT capabilities element 4068 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4069 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 4070 */ 4071 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr { 4072 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID, 4073 4074 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES, 4075 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC, 4076 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY, 4077 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET, 4078 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE, 4079 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA, 4080 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS, 4081 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC, 4082 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY, 4083 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET, 4084 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE, 4085 4086 /* keep last */ 4087 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4088 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4089 }; 4090 4091 /** 4092 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes 4093 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4094 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band, 4095 * an array of nested frequency attributes 4096 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band, 4097 * an array of nested bitrate attributes 4098 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4099 * defined in 802.11n 4100 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4101 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n 4102 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n 4103 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4104 * defined in 802.11ac 4105 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4106 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using 4107 * attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr 4108 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 4109 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 4110 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. 4111 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 4112 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. 4113 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 4114 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS 4115 * set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes 4116 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the 4117 * S1G information IE, 10 bytes 4118 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 4119 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4120 */ 4121 enum nl80211_band_attr { 4122 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID, 4123 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS, 4124 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES, 4125 4126 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET, 4127 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA, 4128 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR, 4129 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY, 4130 4131 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET, 4132 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA, 4133 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA, 4134 4135 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS, 4136 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 4137 4138 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET, 4139 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA, 4140 4141 /* keep last */ 4142 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4143 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4144 }; 4145 4146 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA 4147 4148 /** 4149 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule 4150 * 4151 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4152 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot. 4153 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot. 4154 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space. 4155 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time. 4156 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule. 4157 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use. 4158 */ 4159 enum nl80211_wmm_rule { 4160 __NL80211_WMMR_INVALID, 4161 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN, 4162 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX, 4163 NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN, 4164 NL80211_WMMR_TXOP, 4165 4166 /* keep last */ 4167 __NL80211_WMMR_LAST, 4168 NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1 4169 }; 4170 4171 /** 4172 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes 4173 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4174 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz 4175 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current 4176 * regulatory domain. 4177 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation 4178 * are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe 4179 * requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing. 4180 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory 4181 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4182 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm 4183 * (100 * dBm). 4184 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS 4185 * (enum nl80211_dfs_state) 4186 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long 4187 * this channel is in this DFS state. 4188 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this 4189 * channel as the control channel 4190 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this 4191 * channel as the control channel 4192 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel 4193 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible, 4194 * this includes 80+80 channels 4195 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel 4196 * using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels 4197 * isn't possible 4198 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4199 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this 4200 * channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be 4201 * used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in 4202 * an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not 4203 * through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master 4204 * that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power. 4205 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this 4206 * channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on 4207 * the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz 4208 * band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS 4209 * off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be 4210 * done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under 4211 * the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS 4212 * off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and 4213 * radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e., 4214 * wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this 4215 * attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP). 4216 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed 4217 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4218 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed 4219 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4220 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations. 4221 * This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC. 4222 * (see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule) 4223 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel 4224 * in current regulatory domain. 4225 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 4226 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed 4227 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4228 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed 4229 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4230 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed 4231 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4232 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed 4233 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4234 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed 4235 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4236 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel 4237 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible 4238 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel 4239 * in current regulatory domain. 4240 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that 4241 * is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4242 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number 4243 * currently defined 4244 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4245 * 4246 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122 4247 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed 4248 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and 4249 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT. 4250 */ 4251 enum nl80211_frequency_attr { 4252 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID, 4253 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ, 4254 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED, 4255 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR, 4256 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS, 4257 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR, 4258 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER, 4259 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE, 4260 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME, 4261 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS, 4262 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS, 4263 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ, 4264 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ, 4265 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4266 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY, 4267 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT, 4268 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ, 4269 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ, 4270 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM, 4271 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE, 4272 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET, 4273 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ, 4274 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ, 4275 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ, 4276 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ, 4277 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ, 4278 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ, 4279 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT, 4280 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD, 4281 4282 /* keep last */ 4283 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4284 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4285 }; 4286 4287 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER 4288 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4289 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4290 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4291 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \ 4292 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4293 4294 /** 4295 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes 4296 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4297 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps 4298 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported 4299 * in 2.4 GHz band. 4300 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number 4301 * currently defined 4302 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4303 */ 4304 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr { 4305 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID, 4306 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE, 4307 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE, 4308 4309 /* keep last */ 4310 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4311 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4312 }; 4313 4314 /** 4315 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request 4316 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world 4317 * regulatory domain. 4318 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the 4319 * regulatory domain. 4320 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the 4321 * wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in. 4322 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an 4323 * 802.11 country information element with regulatory information it 4324 * thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country 4325 * code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information 4326 * structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb. 4327 * If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should 4328 * be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation. 4329 */ 4330 enum nl80211_reg_initiator { 4331 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE, 4332 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER, 4333 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, 4334 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE, 4335 }; 4336 4337 /** 4338 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain 4339 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains 4340 * to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the 4341 * ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid. 4342 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory 4343 * domain. 4344 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom 4345 * driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide 4346 * and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested 4347 * them to be applied. 4348 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product 4349 * of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously 4350 * set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory 4351 * domain request to be processed. 4352 */ 4353 enum nl80211_reg_type { 4354 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY, 4355 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD, 4356 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD, 4357 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION, 4358 }; 4359 4360 /** 4361 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes 4362 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4363 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional 4364 * considerations for a given frequency range. These are the 4365 * &enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags. 4366 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory 4367 * rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory 4368 * band edge. 4369 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule 4370 * in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory 4371 * band edge. 4372 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this 4373 * frequency range, in KHz. 4374 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain 4375 * for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi). 4376 * If you don't have one then don't send this. 4377 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for 4378 * a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm). 4379 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4380 * If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used. 4381 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm). 4382 * This could be negative. 4383 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number 4384 * currently defined 4385 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4386 */ 4387 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr { 4388 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID, 4389 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, 4390 4391 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START, 4392 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END, 4393 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW, 4394 4395 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN, 4396 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP, 4397 4398 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4399 4400 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD, 4401 4402 /* keep last */ 4403 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4404 NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4405 }; 4406 4407 /** 4408 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes 4409 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4410 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching, 4411 * only report BSS with matching SSID. 4412 * (This cannot be used together with BSSID.) 4413 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a 4414 * BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that 4415 * if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as 4416 * the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a 4417 * matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with 4418 * how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem, 4419 * the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this 4420 * attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute. 4421 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether 4422 * %NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or 4423 * relative to current bss's RSSI. 4424 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 4425 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 4426 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 4427 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 4428 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching 4429 * (this cannot be used together with SSID). 4430 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the 4431 * band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in 4432 * enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a 4433 * band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one 4434 * of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the 4435 * minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated 4436 * within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such 4437 * attributes will be nested within this attribute. 4438 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter 4439 * attribute number currently defined 4440 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4441 */ 4442 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr { 4443 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID, 4444 4445 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID, 4446 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI, 4447 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI, 4448 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 4449 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID, 4450 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, 4451 4452 /* keep last */ 4453 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4454 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = 4455 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4456 }; 4457 4458 /* only for backward compatibility */ 4459 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID 4460 4461 /** 4462 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags 4463 * 4464 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed 4465 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed 4466 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed 4467 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed 4468 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used 4469 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links 4470 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links 4471 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed, 4472 * this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require 4473 * beaconing. 4474 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated 4475 * base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross 4476 * multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges. 4477 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4478 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation 4479 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation 4480 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed 4481 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed 4482 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed 4483 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed 4484 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed 4485 * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value 4486 */ 4487 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags { 4488 NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM = 1<<0, 4489 NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK = 1<<1, 4490 NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR = 1<<2, 4491 NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR = 1<<3, 4492 NL80211_RRF_DFS = 1<<4, 4493 NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY = 1<<5, 4494 NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY = 1<<6, 4495 NL80211_RRF_NO_IR = 1<<7, 4496 __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS = 1<<8, 4497 NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW = 1<<11, 4498 NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<12, 4499 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<13, 4500 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<14, 4501 NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ = 1<<15, 4502 NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ = 1<<16, 4503 NL80211_RRF_NO_HE = 1<<17, 4504 NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ = 1<<18, 4505 NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT = 1<<19, 4506 NL80211_RRF_PSD = 1<<20, 4507 }; 4508 4509 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4510 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4511 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4512 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40 (NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\ 4513 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS) 4514 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT 4515 4516 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */ 4517 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL (NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS) 4518 4519 /** 4520 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions 4521 * 4522 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified 4523 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC 4524 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI 4525 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec 4526 */ 4527 enum nl80211_dfs_regions { 4528 NL80211_DFS_UNSET = 0, 4529 NL80211_DFS_FCC = 1, 4530 NL80211_DFS_ETSI = 2, 4531 NL80211_DFS_JP = 3, 4532 }; 4533 4534 /** 4535 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint 4536 * 4537 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always 4538 * assumed if the attribute is not set. 4539 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular 4540 * base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work 4541 * properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints 4542 * by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature 4543 * capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will 4544 * ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device 4545 * present has been registered with the wireless core that 4546 * has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a 4547 * supported feature. 4548 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the 4549 * platform is operating in an indoor environment. 4550 */ 4551 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type { 4552 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER = 0, 4553 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1, 4554 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR = 2, 4555 }; 4556 4557 /** 4558 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information 4559 * 4560 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO 4561 * when getting information about a survey. 4562 * 4563 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4564 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel 4565 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm) 4566 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 4567 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio 4568 * was turned on (on channel or globally) 4569 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary 4570 * channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect) 4571 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension 4572 * channel was sensed busy 4573 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4574 * receiving data (on channel or globally) 4575 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent 4576 * transmitting data (on channel or globally) 4577 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan 4578 * (on this channel or globally) 4579 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 4580 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4581 * receiving frames destined to the local BSS 4582 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number 4583 * currently defined 4584 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz 4585 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4586 */ 4587 enum nl80211_survey_info { 4588 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID, 4589 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY, 4590 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE, 4591 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE, 4592 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME, 4593 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY, 4594 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY, 4595 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX, 4596 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX, 4597 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN, 4598 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD, 4599 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX, 4600 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 4601 4602 /* keep last */ 4603 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 4604 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 4605 }; 4606 4607 /* keep old names for compatibility */ 4608 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME 4609 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY 4610 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY 4611 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX 4612 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX 4613 4614 /** 4615 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags 4616 * 4617 * Monitor configuration flags. 4618 * 4619 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved 4620 * 4621 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 4622 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 4623 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 4624 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 4625 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing. 4626 * overrides all other flags. 4627 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address 4628 * and ACK incoming unicast packets. 4629 * 4630 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4631 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag 4632 */ 4633 enum nl80211_mntr_flags { 4634 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 4635 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 4636 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 4637 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 4638 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 4639 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 4640 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 4641 4642 /* keep last */ 4643 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 4644 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 4645 }; 4646 4647 /** 4648 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes 4649 * 4650 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is 4651 * not known or has not been set yet. 4652 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is 4653 * in Awake state all the time. 4654 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4655 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for 4656 * neighbor's beacons. 4657 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4658 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up 4659 * for neighbor's beacons. 4660 * 4661 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use 4662 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level 4663 */ 4664 4665 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode { 4666 NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN, 4667 NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE, 4668 NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP, 4669 NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP, 4670 4671 __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST, 4672 NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1 4673 }; 4674 4675 /** 4676 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters 4677 * 4678 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is 4679 * active. 4680 * 4681 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use 4682 * 4683 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in 4684 * millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message 4685 * 4686 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in 4687 * millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link 4688 * 4689 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in 4690 * millisecond units 4691 * 4692 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed 4693 * on this mesh interface 4694 * 4695 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link 4696 * open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a 4697 * mesh 4698 * 4699 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh 4700 * point. 4701 * 4702 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open 4703 * peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if 4704 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are 4705 * set. 4706 * 4707 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames 4708 * containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path 4709 * target) 4710 * 4711 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths 4712 * (in milliseconds) 4713 * 4714 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait 4715 * until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds) 4716 * 4717 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh 4718 * points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from 4719 * the root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 4720 * 4721 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4722 * TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 4723 * reference element 4724 * 4725 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs) 4726 * that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the 4727 * mesh 4728 * 4729 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not 4730 * 4731 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a 4732 * source mesh point for path selection elements. 4733 * 4734 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4735 * root announcements are transmitted. 4736 * 4737 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has 4738 * access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. This is done via Root 4739 * Announcement frames. 4740 * 4741 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4742 * TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a 4743 * PERR element. 4744 * 4745 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding 4746 * or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 4747 * 4748 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the 4749 * threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish 4750 * a peer link. 4751 * 4752 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors 4753 * to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 4754 * (see 11C.12.2.2) 4755 * 4756 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode. 4757 * 4758 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute 4759 * 4760 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for 4761 * which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding 4762 * information to the root mesh STA to be valid. 4763 * 4764 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4765 * proactive PREQs are transmitted. 4766 * 4767 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time 4768 * (in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame 4769 * containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 4770 * 4771 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links. 4772 * type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32) 4773 * 4774 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs) 4775 * 4776 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've 4777 * established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then 4778 * remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable 4779 * the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes. 4780 * 4781 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA 4782 * will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation 4783 * field. If left unset then the mesh formation field will only 4784 * advertise such if there is an active root mesh path. 4785 * 4786 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. 4787 * PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that 4788 * this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be 4789 * better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 4790 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 4791 * 4792 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA 4793 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 4794 * in the mesh formation field. 4795 * 4796 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4797 */ 4798 enum nl80211_meshconf_params { 4799 __NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID, 4800 NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT, 4801 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT, 4802 NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT, 4803 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS, 4804 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES, 4805 NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL, 4806 NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS, 4807 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES, 4808 NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME, 4809 NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 4810 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT, 4811 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL, 4812 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME, 4813 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE, 4814 NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL, 4815 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL, 4816 NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS, 4817 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL, 4818 NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING, 4819 NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD, 4820 NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR, 4821 NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE, 4822 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT, 4823 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL, 4824 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL, 4825 NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE, 4826 NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW, 4827 NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT, 4828 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 4829 NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN, 4830 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 4831 4832 /* keep last */ 4833 __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4834 NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4835 }; 4836 4837 /** 4838 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters 4839 * 4840 * Mesh setup parameters. These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be 4841 * changed while the mesh is active. 4842 * 4843 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use 4844 * 4845 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a 4846 * vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the 4847 * default HWMP. 4848 * 4849 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a 4850 * vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime 4851 * metric. 4852 * 4853 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a 4854 * robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element 4855 * that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and 4856 * metrics in use. 4857 * 4858 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication 4859 * daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates. 4860 * 4861 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication 4862 * daemon will be securing peer link frames. AMPE is a secured version of 4863 * Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of 4864 * a userspace daemon. When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer 4865 * management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE 4866 * functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and 4867 * key management). When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can 4868 * autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a 4869 * userspace daemon. 4870 * 4871 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a 4872 * vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default 4873 * neighbor offset synchronization 4874 * 4875 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will 4876 * implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state. 4877 * 4878 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication 4879 * method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE). 4880 * Default is no authentication method required. 4881 * 4882 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number 4883 * 4884 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use 4885 */ 4886 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params { 4887 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID, 4888 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL, 4889 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC, 4890 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE, 4891 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 4892 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, 4893 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC, 4894 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM, 4895 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL, 4896 4897 /* keep last */ 4898 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4899 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4900 }; 4901 4902 /** 4903 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes 4904 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved 4905 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*) 4906 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning 4907 * disabled 4908 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 4909 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4910 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 4911 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4912 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 4913 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 4914 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number 4915 */ 4916 enum nl80211_txq_attr { 4917 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID, 4918 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC, 4919 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP, 4920 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN, 4921 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX, 4922 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS, 4923 4924 /* keep last */ 4925 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4926 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4927 }; 4928 4929 enum nl80211_ac { 4930 NL80211_AC_VO, 4931 NL80211_AC_VI, 4932 NL80211_AC_BE, 4933 NL80211_AC_BK, 4934 NL80211_NUM_ACS 4935 }; 4936 4937 /* backward compat */ 4938 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC 4939 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO NL80211_AC_VO 4940 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI NL80211_AC_VI 4941 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE NL80211_AC_BE 4942 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK NL80211_AC_BK 4943 4944 /** 4945 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type 4946 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4947 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel 4948 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4949 * below the control channel 4950 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4951 * above the control channel 4952 */ 4953 enum nl80211_channel_type { 4954 NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT, 4955 NL80211_CHAN_HT20, 4956 NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS, 4957 NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS 4958 }; 4959 4960 /** 4961 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode 4962 * 4963 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default) 4964 * Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately 4965 * 4966 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the 4967 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: 4968 * 4969 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: 4970 * Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet 4971 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: 4972 * The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes 4973 * the preferred Tx key for the station. 4974 */ 4975 enum nl80211_key_mode { 4976 NL80211_KEY_RX_TX, 4977 NL80211_KEY_NO_TX, 4978 NL80211_KEY_SET_TX 4979 }; 4980 4981 /** 4982 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions 4983 * 4984 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH 4985 * attribute. 4986 * 4987 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4988 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel 4989 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4990 * attribute must be provided as well 4991 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4992 * attribute must be provided as well 4993 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4994 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well 4995 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4996 * attribute must be provided as well 4997 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel 4998 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel 4999 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel 5000 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel 5001 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel 5002 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel 5003 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel 5004 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 5005 * attribute must be provided as well 5006 */ 5007 enum nl80211_chan_width { 5008 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT, 5009 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 5010 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40, 5011 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80, 5012 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80, 5013 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160, 5014 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 5015 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 5016 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 5017 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 5018 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4, 5019 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8, 5020 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16, 5021 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320, 5022 }; 5023 5024 /** 5025 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS 5026 * 5027 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute. 5028 * 5029 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible 5030 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide 5031 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide 5032 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide 5033 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide 5034 */ 5035 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width { 5036 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 5037 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 5038 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 5039 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 5040 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 5041 }; 5042 5043 /** 5044 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS 5045 * 5046 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid 5047 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets) 5048 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32) 5049 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64) 5050 * (if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be 5051 * from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon 5052 * that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from) 5053 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16) 5054 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16) 5055 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the 5056 * raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin); 5057 * if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is 5058 * different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise 5059 * they are from a Beacon frame. 5060 * However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these 5061 * IEs may be from either frame subtype. 5062 * If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the 5063 * data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics. 5064 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon 5065 * in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32) 5066 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon 5067 * in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8) 5068 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used" 5069 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms 5070 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information 5071 * elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has 5072 * yet been received 5073 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel 5074 * (u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used! 5075 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64) 5076 * (not present if no beacon frame has been received yet) 5077 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and 5078 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute) 5079 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry 5080 * was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be 5081 * accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 5082 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 5083 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first 5084 * octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for 5085 * this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by 5086 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64). 5087 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF 5088 * is set. 5089 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update. 5090 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm), 5091 * using the nesting index as the antenna number. 5092 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 5093 * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8). 5094 * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it. 5095 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal 5096 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute 5097 */ 5098 enum nl80211_bss { 5099 __NL80211_BSS_INVALID, 5100 NL80211_BSS_BSSID, 5101 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY, 5102 NL80211_BSS_TSF, 5103 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL, 5104 NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY, 5105 NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS, 5106 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM, 5107 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 5108 NL80211_BSS_STATUS, 5109 NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO, 5110 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES, 5111 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH, 5112 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF, 5113 NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA, 5114 NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME, 5115 NL80211_BSS_PAD, 5116 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 5117 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID, 5118 NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 5119 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 5120 NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID, 5121 NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR, 5122 5123 /* keep last */ 5124 __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST, 5125 NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1 5126 }; 5127 5128 /** 5129 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status" 5130 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS. 5131 * Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer 5132 * keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with 5133 * a given BSS. 5134 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS. 5135 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS. 5136 * 5137 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which 5138 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS. 5139 */ 5140 enum nl80211_bss_status { 5141 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED, 5142 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED, 5143 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED, 5144 }; 5145 5146 /** 5147 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType 5148 * 5149 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication 5150 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only) 5151 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r) 5152 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP) 5153 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals 5154 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key 5155 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS 5156 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key 5157 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal 5158 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm 5159 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by 5160 * trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out 5161 * the attribute for this on CONNECT commands. 5162 */ 5163 enum nl80211_auth_type { 5164 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM, 5165 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY, 5166 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT, 5167 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP, 5168 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE, 5169 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK, 5170 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS, 5171 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK, 5172 5173 /* keep last */ 5174 __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM, 5175 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1, 5176 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC 5177 }; 5178 5179 /** 5180 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type 5181 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key 5182 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key 5183 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS) 5184 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types 5185 */ 5186 enum nl80211_key_type { 5187 NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP, 5188 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE, 5189 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY, 5190 5191 NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES 5192 }; 5193 5194 /** 5195 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state 5196 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used 5197 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required 5198 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional 5199 */ 5200 enum nl80211_mfp { 5201 NL80211_MFP_NO, 5202 NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED, 5203 NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL, 5204 }; 5205 5206 enum nl80211_wpa_versions { 5207 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0, 5208 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1, 5209 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2, 5210 }; 5211 5212 /** 5213 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types 5214 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid 5215 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default 5216 * unicast key 5217 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default 5218 * multicast key 5219 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types 5220 */ 5221 enum nl80211_key_default_types { 5222 __NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID, 5223 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST, 5224 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST, 5225 5226 NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES 5227 }; 5228 5229 /** 5230 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes 5231 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid 5232 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 5233 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 5234 * keys 5235 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 5236 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 5237 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 5238 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 5239 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 5240 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key 5241 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key 5242 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not 5243 * specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was 5244 * given with the command using the key or not (u32) 5245 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 5246 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 5247 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 5248 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode. 5249 * Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX. 5250 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key 5251 * 5252 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal 5253 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute 5254 */ 5255 enum nl80211_key_attributes { 5256 __NL80211_KEY_INVALID, 5257 NL80211_KEY_DATA, 5258 NL80211_KEY_IDX, 5259 NL80211_KEY_CIPHER, 5260 NL80211_KEY_SEQ, 5261 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT, 5262 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 5263 NL80211_KEY_TYPE, 5264 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 5265 NL80211_KEY_MODE, 5266 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON, 5267 5268 /* keep last */ 5269 __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST, 5270 NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1 5271 }; 5272 5273 /** 5274 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes 5275 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid 5276 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5277 * in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with 5278 * 1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most 5279 * %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array). 5280 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5281 * in an array of MCS numbers. 5282 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5283 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht 5284 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi 5285 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5286 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_he 5287 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us. 5288 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF. 5289 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal 5290 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute 5291 */ 5292 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes { 5293 __NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID, 5294 NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY, 5295 NL80211_TXRATE_HT, 5296 NL80211_TXRATE_VHT, 5297 NL80211_TXRATE_GI, 5298 NL80211_TXRATE_HE, 5299 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI, 5300 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF, 5301 5302 /* keep last */ 5303 __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST, 5304 NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1 5305 }; 5306 5307 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT 5308 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX 8 5309 5310 /** 5311 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5312 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5313 */ 5314 struct nl80211_txrate_vht { 5315 __u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 5316 }; 5317 5318 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX 8 5319 /** 5320 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5321 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5322 */ 5323 struct nl80211_txrate_he { 5324 __u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 5325 }; 5326 5327 enum nl80211_txrate_gi { 5328 NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI, 5329 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI, 5330 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI, 5331 }; 5332 5333 /** 5334 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band 5335 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band 5336 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz) 5337 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz) 5338 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz) 5339 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs 5340 * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder) 5341 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace 5342 * since newer kernel versions may support more bands 5343 */ 5344 enum nl80211_band { 5345 NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, 5346 NL80211_BAND_5GHZ, 5347 NL80211_BAND_60GHZ, 5348 NL80211_BAND_6GHZ, 5349 NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ, 5350 NL80211_BAND_LC, 5351 5352 NUM_NL80211_BANDS, 5353 }; 5354 5355 /** 5356 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state 5357 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled 5358 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled 5359 */ 5360 enum nl80211_ps_state { 5361 NL80211_PS_DISABLED, 5362 NL80211_PS_ENABLED, 5363 }; 5364 5365 /** 5366 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes 5367 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid 5368 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies 5369 * the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero 5370 * to disable. Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is 5371 * set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of 5372 * threshold values in dBm. Events will be sent when the RSSI value 5373 * crosses any of the thresholds. 5374 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies 5375 * the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a 5376 * new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation). 5377 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event 5378 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many 5379 * consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer 5380 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures 5381 * during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an 5382 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and 5383 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated. 5384 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given 5385 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is 5386 * checked. 5387 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic 5388 * interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and 5389 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an 5390 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting. 5391 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon 5392 * loss event 5393 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the 5394 * RSSI threshold event. 5395 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal 5396 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute 5397 */ 5398 enum nl80211_attr_cqm { 5399 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID, 5400 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD, 5401 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST, 5402 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT, 5403 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT, 5404 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE, 5405 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS, 5406 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL, 5407 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5408 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL, 5409 5410 /* keep last */ 5411 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST, 5412 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1 5413 }; 5414 5415 /** 5416 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event 5417 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the 5418 * configured threshold 5419 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the 5420 * configured threshold 5421 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent) 5422 */ 5423 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event { 5424 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW, 5425 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH, 5426 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5427 }; 5428 5429 5430 /** 5431 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment 5432 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power 5433 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter 5434 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter 5435 */ 5436 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting { 5437 NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC, 5438 NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED, 5439 NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED, 5440 }; 5441 5442 /** 5443 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state 5444 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID 5445 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID 5446 */ 5447 enum nl80211_tid_config { 5448 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE, 5449 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE, 5450 }; 5451 5452 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type 5453 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate 5454 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter 5455 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter 5456 */ 5457 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting { 5458 NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC, 5459 NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED, 5460 NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED, 5461 }; 5462 5463 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration. 5464 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values 5465 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported 5466 * for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic 5467 * (%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE). 5468 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but 5469 * per peer instead. 5470 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates 5471 * that the new configuration overrides all previous peer 5472 * configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations 5473 * should be left untouched. 5474 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7) 5475 * Its type is u16. 5476 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID. 5477 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config. 5478 * Its type is u8. 5479 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame 5480 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5481 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and 5482 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5483 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5484 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame 5485 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5486 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and 5487 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5488 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5489 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 5490 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5491 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5492 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs 5493 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using 5494 * the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5495 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 5496 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5497 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5498 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful 5499 * to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used 5500 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using 5501 * the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting. 5502 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied 5503 * with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES. 5504 * configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected 5505 * station. 5506 */ 5507 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr { 5508 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 5509 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD, 5510 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP, 5511 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP, 5512 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE, 5513 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, 5514 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK, 5515 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT, 5516 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG, 5517 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL, 5518 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL, 5519 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL, 5520 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE, 5521 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE, 5522 5523 /* keep last */ 5524 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 5525 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 5526 }; 5527 5528 /** 5529 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute 5530 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5531 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has 5532 * a zero bit are ignored 5533 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have 5534 * a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds 5535 * to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are 5536 * in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern 5537 * corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask. 5538 * For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where 5539 * xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of 5540 * twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01". 5541 * Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not 5542 * 802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked 5543 * first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched. 5544 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after 5545 * these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5546 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes 5547 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number 5548 */ 5549 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr { 5550 __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID, 5551 NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK, 5552 NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN, 5553 NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET, 5554 5555 NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT, 5556 MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1, 5557 }; 5558 5559 /** 5560 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information 5561 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported 5562 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern 5563 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern 5564 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5565 * 5566 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when 5567 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in 5568 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of 5569 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given 5570 * by the kernel to userspace. 5571 */ 5572 struct nl80211_pattern_support { 5573 __u32 max_patterns; 5574 __u32 min_pattern_len; 5575 __u32 max_pattern_len; 5576 __u32 max_pkt_offset; 5577 } __attribute__((packed)); 5578 5579 /* only for backward compatibility */ 5580 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID 5581 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5582 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN 5583 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET 5584 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT 5585 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT 5586 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support 5587 5588 /** 5589 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions 5590 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5591 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put 5592 * the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have 5593 * support for low-power operation already (flag) 5594 * Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if 5595 * any others are even supported by the device. 5596 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect 5597 * is detected is implementation-specific (flag) 5598 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed 5599 * by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag) 5600 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns 5601 * which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute 5602 * defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern. 5603 * Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with 5604 * each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is 5605 * done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the 5606 * pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU. 5607 * 5608 * In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute 5609 * carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support. 5610 * 5611 * When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based 5612 * index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed 5613 * to the kernel when configuring. 5614 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be 5615 * used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported 5616 * by the device (flag) 5617 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if 5618 * done by the device) (flag) 5619 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request 5620 * packet (flag) 5621 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag) 5622 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released 5623 * (on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag) 5624 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains 5625 * the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame 5626 * may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN 5627 * attribute contains the original length. 5628 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11 5629 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211 5630 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5631 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the 5632 * 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may 5633 * be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute 5634 * contains the original length. 5635 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3 5636 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023 5637 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5638 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section 5639 * "TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute 5640 * containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive 5641 * the TCP connection. 5642 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the 5643 * wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection 5644 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the 5645 * TCP connection was lost or failed to be established 5646 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only, 5647 * the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the 5648 * service 5649 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network 5650 * is detected. This is a nested attribute that contains the 5651 * same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN. It 5652 * specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the 5653 * channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan 5654 * results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets). This 5655 * attribute is also sent in a response to 5656 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets 5657 * supported by the driver (u32). 5658 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute 5659 * containing an array with information about what triggered the 5660 * wake up. If no elements are present in the array, it means 5661 * that the information is not available. If more than one 5662 * element is present, it means that more than one match 5663 * occurred. 5664 * Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains 5665 * one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional 5666 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute. At least one of 5667 * these attributes must be present. If 5668 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one 5669 * frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one 5670 * channel. 5671 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers 5672 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number 5673 * 5674 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and 5675 * to report the wakeup reason(s). 5676 */ 5677 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers { 5678 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID, 5679 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY, 5680 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT, 5681 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT, 5682 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN, 5683 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED, 5684 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE, 5685 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST, 5686 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE, 5687 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE, 5688 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211, 5689 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN, 5690 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023, 5691 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN, 5692 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION, 5693 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH, 5694 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST, 5695 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS, 5696 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT, 5697 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS, 5698 5699 /* keep last */ 5700 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG, 5701 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1 5702 }; 5703 5704 /** 5705 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup 5706 * 5707 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a 5708 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If 5709 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given 5710 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data 5711 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK. 5712 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence 5713 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also 5714 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive 5715 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc. 5716 * 5717 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the 5718 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern 5719 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the 5720 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is 5721 * also woken up. 5722 * 5723 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP 5724 * response packets might not go through correctly. 5725 */ 5726 5727 /** 5728 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence 5729 * @start: starting value 5730 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet 5731 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4 5732 * 5733 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the 5734 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet 5735 * in little endian. 5736 */ 5737 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq { 5738 __u32 start, offset, len; 5739 }; 5740 5741 /** 5742 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config 5743 * @offset: offset of token in packet 5744 * @len: length of each token 5745 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must 5746 * be a multiple of @len for this to make sense 5747 */ 5748 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token { 5749 __u32 offset, len; 5750 __u8 token_stream[]; 5751 }; 5752 5753 /** 5754 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features 5755 * @min_len: minimum token length 5756 * @max_len: maximum token length 5757 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream) 5758 */ 5759 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature { 5760 __u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize; 5761 }; 5762 5763 /** 5764 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters 5765 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5766 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order) 5767 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address 5768 * (in network byte order) 5769 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because 5770 * route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend, 5771 * and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it 5772 * might require ARP querying. 5773 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a 5774 * socket and port will be allocated 5775 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16) 5776 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte. 5777 * For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5778 * of the data payload. 5779 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration 5780 * (if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature 5781 * advertising it is just a flag 5782 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration, 5783 * see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see 5784 * &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature. 5785 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum 5786 * interval in feature advertising (u32) 5787 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a 5788 * u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5789 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for 5790 * feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5791 * but on the TCP payload only. 5792 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes 5793 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number 5794 */ 5795 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs { 5796 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID, 5797 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4, 5798 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4, 5799 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC, 5800 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT, 5801 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT, 5802 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD, 5803 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ, 5804 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN, 5805 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL, 5806 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD, 5807 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK, 5808 5809 /* keep last */ 5810 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP, 5811 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1 5812 }; 5813 5814 /** 5815 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information 5816 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported 5817 * @pat: packet pattern support information 5818 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5819 * 5820 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the 5821 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace. 5822 */ 5823 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support { 5824 __u32 max_rules; 5825 struct nl80211_pattern_support pat; 5826 __u32 max_delay; 5827 } __attribute__((packed)); 5828 5829 /** 5830 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute 5831 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5832 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing 5833 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence, 5834 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 5835 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched 5836 * after these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5837 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes 5838 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number 5839 */ 5840 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule { 5841 __NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID, 5842 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY, 5843 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION, 5844 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN, 5845 5846 /* keep last */ 5847 NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 5848 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1 5849 }; 5850 5851 /** 5852 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions 5853 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns 5854 * in a rule are matched. 5855 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns 5856 * in a rule are not matched. 5857 */ 5858 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition { 5859 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH, 5860 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH 5861 }; 5862 5863 /** 5864 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes 5865 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5866 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that 5867 * can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32) 5868 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a 5869 * flag attribute for each interface type in this set 5870 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes 5871 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number 5872 */ 5873 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs { 5874 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC, 5875 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX, 5876 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES, 5877 5878 /* keep last */ 5879 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT, 5880 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1 5881 }; 5882 5883 /** 5884 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes 5885 * 5886 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5887 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits 5888 * for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs. 5889 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of 5890 * interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't 5891 * apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed 5892 * in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE. 5893 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that 5894 * beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for 5895 * infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt 5896 * the infrastructure network's beacon interval. 5897 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many 5898 * different channels may be used within this group. 5899 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5900 * of supported channel widths for radar detection. 5901 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5902 * of supported regulatory regions for radar detection. 5903 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of 5904 * different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations 5905 * in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical). 5906 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes 5907 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number 5908 * 5909 * Examples: 5910 * limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2 5911 * => allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs 5912 * 5913 * numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8, 5914 * => allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd 5915 * 5916 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2 5917 * => allows two STAs on the same or on different channels 5918 * 5919 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4 5920 * => allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces 5921 * 5922 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained 5923 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate 5924 * that any of these groups must match. 5925 * 5926 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here, 5927 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always 5928 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid 5929 * interface type, the following group always exists: 5930 * numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1 5931 */ 5932 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs { 5933 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC, 5934 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS, 5935 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM, 5936 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH, 5937 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS, 5938 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS, 5939 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS, 5940 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD, 5941 5942 /* keep last */ 5943 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB, 5944 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1 5945 }; 5946 5947 5948 /** 5949 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine 5950 * 5951 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit 5952 * state of non existent mesh peer links 5953 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to 5954 * this mesh peer 5955 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received 5956 * from this mesh peer 5957 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been 5958 * received from this mesh peer 5959 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established 5960 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled 5961 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh 5962 * plink are discarded, except for authentication frames 5963 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states 5964 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states 5965 */ 5966 enum nl80211_plink_state { 5967 NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN, 5968 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT, 5969 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD, 5970 NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD, 5971 NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB, 5972 NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING, 5973 NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED, 5974 5975 /* keep last */ 5976 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES, 5977 MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1 5978 }; 5979 5980 /** 5981 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers 5982 * 5983 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action 5984 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment 5985 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer 5986 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions 5987 */ 5988 enum plink_actions { 5989 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION, 5990 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN, 5991 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK, 5992 5993 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS, 5994 }; 5995 5996 5997 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN 16 5998 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN 16 5999 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN 24 6000 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN 32 6001 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32 32 6002 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN 8 6003 6004 /** 6005 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload 6006 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 6007 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary) 6008 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary) 6009 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary) 6010 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type) 6011 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal) 6012 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal) 6013 */ 6014 enum nl80211_rekey_data { 6015 __NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID, 6016 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK, 6017 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK, 6018 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR, 6019 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM, 6020 6021 /* keep last */ 6022 NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA, 6023 MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1 6024 }; 6025 6026 /** 6027 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID 6028 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in 6029 * Beacon frames) 6030 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element 6031 * in Beacon frames 6032 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID 6033 * element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID 6034 */ 6035 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid { 6036 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE, 6037 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN, 6038 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS 6039 }; 6040 6041 /** 6042 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes 6043 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 6044 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format 6045 * is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field. 6046 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same 6047 * as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down). 6048 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal 6049 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute 6050 */ 6051 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr { 6052 __NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID, 6053 NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES, 6054 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP, 6055 6056 /* keep last */ 6057 __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST, 6058 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1 6059 }; 6060 6061 /** 6062 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates 6063 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 6064 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher 6065 * priority) 6066 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets) 6067 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag) 6068 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes 6069 * (internal) 6070 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute 6071 * (internal) 6072 */ 6073 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr { 6074 __NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID, 6075 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX, 6076 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID, 6077 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH, 6078 6079 /* keep last */ 6080 NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 6081 MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1 6082 }; 6083 6084 /** 6085 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION 6086 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request 6087 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link 6088 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established 6089 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link 6090 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link 6091 */ 6092 enum nl80211_tdls_operation { 6093 NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ, 6094 NL80211_TDLS_SETUP, 6095 NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN, 6096 NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK, 6097 NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK, 6098 }; 6099 6100 /** 6101 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features 6102 * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver 6103 * when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during 6104 * "start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT. 6105 */ 6106 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features { 6107 NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD = 1 << 0, 6108 }; 6109 6110 /** 6111 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features 6112 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back 6113 * TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the 6114 * socket option. 6115 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates. 6116 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up 6117 * the connected inactive stations in AP mode. 6118 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested 6119 * to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from 6120 * cellular base stations. 6121 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only 6122 * here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility) 6123 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of 6124 * equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station 6125 * mode 6126 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan 6127 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported 6128 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif 6129 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting 6130 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform 6131 * OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only 6132 * for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied. 6133 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window 6134 * setting 6135 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic 6136 * powersave 6137 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state 6138 * transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver 6139 * doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding 6140 * stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated 6141 * state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag 6142 * they should be added before even sending the authentication reply 6143 * and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized 6144 * states using station flags. 6145 * Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add 6146 * stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated 6147 * stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask. 6148 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits 6149 * (HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set 6150 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh 6151 * Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for 6152 * beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is 6153 * still generated by the driver. 6154 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor 6155 * interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor 6156 * interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming 6157 * unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed. 6158 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic 6159 * channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the 6160 * lifetime of a BSS. 6161 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter 6162 * Set IE to probe requests. 6163 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE 6164 * to probe requests. 6165 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period 6166 * requests sent to it by an AP. 6167 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the 6168 * current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum 6169 * management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link 6170 * Measurement Report action frame. 6171 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout 6172 * estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used 6173 * to enable dynack. 6174 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial 6175 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6176 * even on HT connections that should be using more chains. 6177 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial 6178 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6179 * and then wake the rest up as required after, for example, 6180 * rts/cts handshake. 6181 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM 6182 * TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS 6183 * command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it 6184 * needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things. 6185 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring 6186 * the vif's MAC address upon creation. 6187 * See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h). 6188 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when 6189 * operating as a TDLS peer. 6190 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6191 * random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the 6192 * %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC 6193 * address mask/value will be used. 6194 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports 6195 * using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled 6196 * scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6197 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6198 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6199 * random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e. 6200 * scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6201 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6202 */ 6203 enum nl80211_feature_flags { 6204 NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS = 1 << 0, 6205 NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS = 1 << 1, 6206 NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER = 1 << 2, 6207 NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS = 1 << 3, 6208 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL = 1 << 4, 6209 NL80211_FEATURE_SAE = 1 << 5, 6210 NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN = 1 << 6, 6211 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH = 1 << 7, 6212 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN = 1 << 8, 6213 NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER = 1 << 9, 6214 NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN = 1 << 10, 6215 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN = 1 << 11, 6216 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS = 1 << 12, 6217 /* bit 13 is reserved */ 6218 NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS = 1 << 14, 6219 NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE = 1 << 15, 6220 NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM = 1 << 16, 6221 NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR = 1 << 17, 6222 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE = 1 << 18, 6223 NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 19, 6224 NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 20, 6225 NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET = 1 << 21, 6226 NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION = 1 << 22, 6227 NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION = 1 << 23, 6228 NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS = 1 << 24, 6229 NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS = 1 << 25, 6230 NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION = 1 << 26, 6231 NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE = 1 << 27, 6232 NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = 1 << 28, 6233 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 29, 6234 NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 30, 6235 NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1U << 31, 6236 }; 6237 6238 /** 6239 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features. 6240 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates. 6241 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can 6242 * request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with 6243 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set 6244 * the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if 6245 * NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized. 6246 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air 6247 * sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from 6248 * certain groups which can be configured by the 6249 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute, 6250 * or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the 6251 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute. 6252 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual 6253 * time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of 6254 * the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 6255 * (if available). 6256 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the 6257 * time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the 6258 * BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 6259 * (if available). 6260 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of 6261 * channel dwell time. 6262 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate 6263 * configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate. 6264 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate 6265 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates. 6266 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate 6267 * configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates. 6268 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup 6269 * with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode. 6270 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA 6271 * in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated. 6272 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports 6273 * randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated. 6274 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan 6275 * for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS 6276 * (%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI). 6277 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the 6278 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more 6279 * RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold. 6280 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key 6281 * authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 6282 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6283 * handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect 6284 * and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported. 6285 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way 6286 * handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host 6287 * and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not 6288 * be supported. 6289 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding 6290 * the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the 6291 * actual dwell time. 6292 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe 6293 * response 6294 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending 6295 * the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps. 6296 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports 6297 * probe request tx deferral and suppression 6298 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL 6299 * value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP. 6300 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan. 6301 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan. 6302 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan. 6303 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions. 6304 * Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself, 6305 * informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event, 6306 * channel change triggered by radar detection event. 6307 * No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to 6308 * "radar detected" event. 6309 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and 6310 * receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice. 6311 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports 6312 * (average) ACK signal strength reporting. 6313 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate 6314 * TXQs. 6315 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the 6316 * SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN. 6317 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data 6318 * except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested 6319 * by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag. 6320 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine 6321 * timing measurement responder role. 6322 * 6323 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are 6324 * able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys 6325 * if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or 6326 * freeze the connection. 6327 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for 6328 * Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016. 6329 * 6330 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime 6331 * fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness 6332 * scheduling. 6333 * 6334 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching 6335 * (set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode. 6336 * 6337 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports 6338 * filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds. 6339 * 6340 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power 6341 * to a station. 6342 * 6343 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in 6344 * station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command). 6345 * 6346 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev 6347 * with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using 6348 * vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case. 6349 * 6350 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL) 6351 * feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission 6352 * time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware. 6353 * 6354 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection 6355 * and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7. 6356 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon 6357 * protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons. 6358 * 6359 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the 6360 * forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then 6361 * handled as ordinary data frames. 6362 * 6363 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames 6364 * 6365 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations 6366 * in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state. 6367 * 6368 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations 6369 * are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly. 6370 * 6371 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and 6372 * reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to 6373 * report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be 6374 * included in the scan request. 6375 * 6376 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver 6377 * can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations. 6378 * 6379 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating 6380 * Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes. 6381 * 6382 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6383 * handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP 6384 * command). 6385 * 6386 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication 6387 * in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command). 6388 * 6389 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery 6390 * frames transmission 6391 * 6392 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports 6393 * unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission 6394 * 6395 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate 6396 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates. 6397 * 6398 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement 6399 * exchange protocol. 6400 * 6401 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement 6402 * exchange protocol. 6403 * 6404 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management 6405 * frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the 6406 * negotiation and range measurement procedure. 6407 * 6408 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision 6409 * detection and change announcemnts. 6410 * 6411 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports 6412 * FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response 6413 * frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using 6414 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 6415 * 6416 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC 6417 * detection. 6418 * 6419 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address 6420 * change without having to bring the underlying network device down 6421 * first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the 6422 * origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy 6423 * or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions 6424 * might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations 6425 * in progress, and no active connections. 6426 * 6427 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode. 6428 * 6429 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables 6430 * authentication, data encryption and message integrity. 6431 * 6432 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA 6433 * in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer 6434 * using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 6435 * 6436 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE 6437 * handling in station mode. 6438 * 6439 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE 6440 * handling in AP mode. 6441 * 6442 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features. 6443 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index. 6444 */ 6445 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index { 6446 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS, 6447 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM, 6448 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER, 6449 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME, 6450 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 6451 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL, 6452 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 6453 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 6454 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT, 6455 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA, 6456 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA, 6457 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED, 6458 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 6459 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST, 6460 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD, 6461 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK, 6462 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X, 6463 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME, 6464 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6465 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE, 6466 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION, 6467 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL, 6468 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN, 6469 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN, 6470 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN, 6471 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD, 6472 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 6473 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6474 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 6475 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6476 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS, 6477 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN, 6478 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT, 6479 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0, 6480 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER, 6481 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS, 6482 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING, 6483 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, 6484 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID, 6485 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR, 6486 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD, 6487 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD, 6488 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL, 6489 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION, 6490 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 6491 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT, 6492 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA, 6493 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS, 6494 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT, 6495 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 6496 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS, 6497 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION, 6498 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK, 6499 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP, 6500 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY, 6501 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6502 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE, 6503 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF, 6504 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT, 6505 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE, 6506 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR, 6507 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD, 6508 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 6509 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE, 6510 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT, 6511 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN, 6512 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA, 6513 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD, 6514 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP, 6515 6516 /* add new features before the definition below */ 6517 NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 6518 MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1 6519 }; 6520 6521 /** 6522 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported 6523 * protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW. 6524 * To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute. 6525 * Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported 6526 * protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a 6527 * supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded 6528 * to the host. 6529 * 6530 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1 6531 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2 6532 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P 6533 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u 6534 */ 6535 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr { 6536 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS = 1<<0, 6537 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 = 1<<1, 6538 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P = 1<<2, 6539 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U = 1<<3, 6540 }; 6541 6542 /** 6543 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons 6544 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be 6545 * handled by the AP is reached. 6546 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL. 6547 */ 6548 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason { 6549 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS, 6550 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT, 6551 }; 6552 6553 /** 6554 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons 6555 * 6556 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified. 6557 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out. 6558 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out. 6559 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out. 6560 */ 6561 enum nl80211_timeout_reason { 6562 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED, 6563 NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN, 6564 NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH, 6565 NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC, 6566 }; 6567 6568 /** 6569 * enum nl80211_scan_flags - scan request control flags 6570 * 6571 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling 6572 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN 6573 * requests. 6574 * 6575 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and 6576 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only 6577 * one of them can be used in the request. 6578 * 6579 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority 6580 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning 6581 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured 6582 * as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is 6583 * dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames 6584 * will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only 6585 * when really needed 6586 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or 6587 * for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the 6588 * flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and 6589 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only 6590 * the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder 6591 * randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits, 6592 * locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed. 6593 * This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check 6594 * the nl80211 feature flags for the device. 6595 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS 6596 * request parameters IE in the probe request 6597 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses 6598 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at 6599 * rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel, 6600 * only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate. 6601 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request 6602 * tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms) 6603 * and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame, 6604 * Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers 6605 * a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of 6606 * SSID and/or RSSI. 6607 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to 6608 * accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the 6609 * scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver 6610 * implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get 6611 * impacted with this flag. 6612 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume 6613 * optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to 6614 * optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag. 6615 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan 6616 * results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum 6617 * possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best 6618 * possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning. 6619 * Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag. 6620 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe 6621 * request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being 6622 * possible. 6623 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to 6624 * only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless 6625 * added by userspace explicitly.) 6626 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with 6627 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means 6628 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included. 6629 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by 6630 * 2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the 6631 * information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses 6632 * received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz 6633 * channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set, 6634 * the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of 6635 * probe requests on non PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that 6636 * these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag 6637 * is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be 6638 * scanned if the user space has asked for it. 6639 */ 6640 enum nl80211_scan_flags { 6641 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY = 1<<0, 6642 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH = 1<<1, 6643 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP = 1<<2, 6644 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR = 1<<3, 6645 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME = 1<<4, 6646 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<5, 6647 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE = 1<<6, 6648 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION = 1<<7, 6649 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN = 1<<8, 6650 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER = 1<<9, 6651 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY = 1<<10, 6652 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN = 1<<11, 6653 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT = 1<<12, 6654 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ = 1<<13, 6655 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ = 1<<14, 6656 }; 6657 6658 /** 6659 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy 6660 * 6661 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by 6662 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to 6663 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. 6664 * 6665 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are 6666 * listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed 6667 * in ACL to authenticate. 6668 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed 6669 * in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL. 6670 */ 6671 enum nl80211_acl_policy { 6672 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED, 6673 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED, 6674 }; 6675 6676 /** 6677 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode 6678 * 6679 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode) 6680 * 6681 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas). 6682 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna) 6683 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and 6684 * turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS). 6685 */ 6686 enum nl80211_smps_mode { 6687 NL80211_SMPS_OFF, 6688 NL80211_SMPS_STATIC, 6689 NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 6690 6691 __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST, 6692 NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1 6693 }; 6694 6695 /** 6696 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation 6697 * 6698 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace 6699 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC) 6700 * 6701 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is 6702 * now unusable. 6703 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished, 6704 * the channel is now available. 6705 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no 6706 * change to the channel status. 6707 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is 6708 * over, channel becomes usable. 6709 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this 6710 * non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must 6711 * be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not 6712 * applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever. 6713 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started, 6714 * should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled. 6715 */ 6716 enum nl80211_radar_event { 6717 NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED, 6718 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED, 6719 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED, 6720 NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED, 6721 NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED, 6722 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED, 6723 }; 6724 6725 /** 6726 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels 6727 * 6728 * Channel states used by the DFS code. 6729 * 6730 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability 6731 * check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS. 6732 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it 6733 * is therefore marked as not available. 6734 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available. 6735 */ 6736 enum nl80211_dfs_state { 6737 NL80211_DFS_USABLE, 6738 NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE, 6739 NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE, 6740 }; 6741 6742 /** 6743 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features 6744 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting 6745 * wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute 6746 * %NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the 6747 * wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or 6748 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV. 6749 */ 6750 enum nl80211_protocol_features { 6751 NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP = 1 << 0, 6752 }; 6753 6754 /** 6755 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers 6756 * 6757 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified. 6758 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol. 6759 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol. 6760 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol. 6761 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last. 6762 */ 6763 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id { 6764 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC, 6765 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP, 6766 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL, 6767 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA, 6768 /* add other protocols before this one */ 6769 NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO 6770 }; 6771 6772 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */ 6773 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION 5000 /* msec */ 6774 6775 /** 6776 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame. 6777 * 6778 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt() 6779 * 6780 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver. 6781 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload 6782 * the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that 6783 * advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace 6784 * to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE). 6785 */ 6786 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags { 6787 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0, 6788 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1, 6789 }; 6790 6791 /* 6792 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set 6793 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated 6794 * yet, so that's not valid so far) 6795 */ 6796 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX 0x80000000 6797 6798 /** 6799 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data 6800 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the 6801 * value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID 6802 * may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be 6803 * added to this file when needed. 6804 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command 6805 */ 6806 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info { 6807 __u32 vendor_id; 6808 __u32 subcmd; 6809 }; 6810 6811 /** 6812 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags. 6813 * 6814 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need 6815 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames. 6816 * 6817 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable. 6818 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable. 6819 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable. 6820 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable. 6821 */ 6822 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability { 6823 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0, 6824 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1, 6825 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2, 6826 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3, 6827 }; 6828 6829 /** 6830 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan 6831 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 6832 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In 6833 * seconds (u32). 6834 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this 6835 * scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute 6836 * because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will 6837 * make the scan plan meaningless. 6838 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number 6839 * currently defined 6840 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use 6841 */ 6842 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan { 6843 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID, 6844 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 6845 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 6846 6847 /* keep last */ 6848 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST, 6849 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX = 6850 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1 6851 }; 6852 6853 /** 6854 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters. 6855 * 6856 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value 6857 * of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band. 6858 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB. 6859 */ 6860 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust { 6861 __u8 band; 6862 __s8 delta; 6863 } __attribute__((packed)); 6864 6865 /** 6866 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection. 6867 * 6868 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved. 6869 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection 6870 * is requested. 6871 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS 6872 * selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred. 6873 * When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver 6874 * shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of 6875 * this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32). 6876 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 6877 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 6878 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 6879 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 6880 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number. 6881 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use. 6882 * 6883 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT 6884 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour 6885 * which the driver shall use. 6886 */ 6887 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr { 6888 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID, 6889 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI, 6890 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF, 6891 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 6892 6893 /* keep last */ 6894 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 6895 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 6896 }; 6897 6898 /** 6899 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type 6900 * 6901 * Defines the function type of a NAN function 6902 * 6903 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish 6904 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe 6905 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up 6906 */ 6907 enum nl80211_nan_function_type { 6908 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, 6909 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE, 6910 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, 6911 6912 /* keep last */ 6913 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST, 6914 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1, 6915 }; 6916 6917 /** 6918 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type 6919 * 6920 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames 6921 * 6922 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited 6923 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited 6924 */ 6925 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type { 6926 NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0, 6927 NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1, 6928 }; 6929 6930 /** 6931 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason 6932 * 6933 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function 6934 * 6935 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user 6936 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout 6937 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored 6938 */ 6939 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason { 6940 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST, 6941 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED, 6942 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR, 6943 }; 6944 6945 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6 6946 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff 6947 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff 6948 6949 /** 6950 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes 6951 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid 6952 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8). 6953 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as 6954 * specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute. 6955 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is 6956 * publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery 6957 * Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8. 6958 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited 6959 * publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to 6960 * the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag. 6961 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is 6962 * subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag. 6963 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up. 6964 * The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8. 6965 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type 6966 * is follow up. This is a u8. 6967 * The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. 6968 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the 6969 * follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute. 6970 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a 6971 * close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device. 6972 * This is a flag. 6973 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should 6974 * stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32. 6975 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service 6976 * specific info. This is a binary attribute. 6977 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute. 6978 * See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes. 6979 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested 6980 * attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6981 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a 6982 * nested attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6983 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function. 6984 * Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0. 6985 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason. 6986 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason. 6987 * 6988 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal 6989 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute 6990 */ 6991 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes { 6992 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID, 6993 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE, 6994 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID, 6995 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE, 6996 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST, 6997 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE, 6998 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID, 6999 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID, 7000 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST, 7001 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE, 7002 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL, 7003 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO, 7004 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF, 7005 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER, 7006 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER, 7007 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID, 7008 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON, 7009 7010 /* keep last */ 7011 NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR, 7012 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1 7013 }; 7014 7015 /** 7016 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes 7017 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid 7018 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set. 7019 * This is a flag. 7020 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if 7021 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary. 7022 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if 7023 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8. 7024 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if 7025 * and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested 7026 * attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address. 7027 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal 7028 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute 7029 */ 7030 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes { 7031 __NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID, 7032 NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE, 7033 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF, 7034 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX, 7035 NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS, 7036 7037 /* keep last */ 7038 NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR, 7039 NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1, 7040 }; 7041 7042 /** 7043 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes 7044 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid 7045 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the 7046 * match. This is a nested attribute. 7047 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 7048 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function 7049 * that caused the match. This is a nested attribute. 7050 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 7051 * 7052 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal 7053 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute 7054 */ 7055 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes { 7056 __NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID, 7057 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL, 7058 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER, 7059 7060 /* keep last */ 7061 NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR, 7062 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1 7063 }; 7064 7065 /** 7066 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external 7067 * authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION. 7068 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication. 7069 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication. 7070 */ 7071 enum nl80211_external_auth_action { 7072 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START, 7073 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT, 7074 }; 7075 7076 /** 7077 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement 7078 * responder attributes 7079 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7080 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled 7081 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element 7082 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10), 7083 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 7084 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element 7085 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13), 7086 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 7087 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7088 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute. 7089 */ 7090 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes { 7091 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7092 7093 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED, 7094 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 7095 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 7096 7097 /* keep last */ 7098 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 7099 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7100 }; 7101 7102 /* 7103 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 7104 * 7105 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS 7106 * when getting FTM responder statistics. 7107 * 7108 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 7109 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames 7110 * were ssfully answered (u32) 7111 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the 7112 * frames were successfully answered (u32) 7113 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32) 7114 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32) 7115 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32) 7116 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an 7117 * indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec) 7118 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers - 7119 * triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation 7120 * phase with the responder (u32) 7121 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests 7122 * - initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled 7123 * FTM slot (u32) 7124 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of 7125 * scheduled window (u32) 7126 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore 7127 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 7128 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute 7129 */ 7130 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats { 7131 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID, 7132 NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM, 7133 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM, 7134 NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM, 7135 NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM, 7136 NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM, 7137 NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC, 7138 NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7139 NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM, 7140 NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7141 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD, 7142 7143 /* keep last */ 7144 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST, 7145 NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1 7146 }; 7147 7148 /** 7149 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types 7150 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble 7151 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble 7152 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble 7153 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble 7154 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble 7155 */ 7156 enum nl80211_preamble { 7157 NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY, 7158 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT, 7159 NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT, 7160 NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG, 7161 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE, 7162 }; 7163 7164 /** 7165 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types 7166 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use 7167 * these numbers also for attributes 7168 * 7169 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement 7170 * 7171 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal 7172 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number 7173 */ 7174 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type { 7175 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID, 7176 7177 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM, 7178 7179 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES, 7180 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1 7181 }; 7182 7183 /** 7184 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status 7185 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully 7186 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused 7187 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out 7188 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent 7189 * reason may be available in the response data 7190 */ 7191 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status { 7192 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS, 7193 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED, 7194 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT, 7195 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE, 7196 }; 7197 7198 /** 7199 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes 7200 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7201 * 7202 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7203 * type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the 7204 * enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req. 7205 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported 7206 * (flag attribute) 7207 * 7208 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal 7209 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7210 */ 7211 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req { 7212 __NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7213 7214 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA, 7215 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF, 7216 7217 /* keep last */ 7218 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS, 7219 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1 7220 }; 7221 7222 /** 7223 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes 7224 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7225 * 7226 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7227 * type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums 7228 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp. 7229 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status 7230 * (using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.) 7231 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the 7232 * result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to 7233 * more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 7234 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface 7235 * doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured. 7236 * This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested 7237 * (u64, usec) 7238 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially 7239 * (*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but 7240 * the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single 7241 * result. 7242 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore 7243 * 7244 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal 7245 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7246 */ 7247 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp { 7248 __NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7249 7250 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA, 7251 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS, 7252 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME, 7253 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF, 7254 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL, 7255 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7256 7257 /* keep last */ 7258 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS, 7259 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1 7260 }; 7261 7262 /** 7263 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement 7264 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7265 * 7266 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address 7267 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level 7268 * attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc. 7269 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7270 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7271 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside. 7272 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7273 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7274 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside. 7275 * 7276 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal 7277 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7278 */ 7279 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs { 7280 __NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID, 7281 7282 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR, 7283 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN, 7284 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ, 7285 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP, 7286 7287 /* keep last */ 7288 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS, 7289 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1, 7290 }; 7291 7292 /** 7293 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes 7294 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7295 * 7296 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability 7297 * advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers 7298 * measurements can be done with in a single request 7299 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability 7300 * indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in 7301 * measurement results 7302 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability 7303 * indicating that MAC address randomization is supported. 7304 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device, 7305 * this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and 7306 * type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums 7307 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa. 7308 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is 7309 * meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the 7310 * sub-attributes taken from 7311 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs. 7312 * 7313 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal 7314 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7315 */ 7316 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs { 7317 __NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID, 7318 7319 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS, 7320 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF, 7321 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR, 7322 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA, 7323 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS, 7324 7325 /* keep last */ 7326 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR, 7327 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1 7328 }; 7329 7330 /** 7331 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities 7332 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7333 * 7334 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode 7335 * is supported 7336 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP 7337 * mode is supported 7338 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI 7339 * data can be requested during the measurement 7340 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic 7341 * location data can be requested during the measurement 7342 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits 7343 * from &enum nl80211_preamble. 7344 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from 7345 * &enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel 7346 * bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be 7347 * configured to allow for other measurements types with different 7348 * bandwidth requirement in the same measurement. 7349 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating 7350 * the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything 7351 * is valid) 7352 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating 7353 * the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid) 7354 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if 7355 * trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7356 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating 7357 * if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7358 * 7359 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal 7360 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7361 */ 7362 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa { 7363 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID, 7364 7365 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP, 7366 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP, 7367 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI, 7368 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC, 7369 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES, 7370 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS, 7371 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT, 7372 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7373 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7374 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7375 7376 /* keep last */ 7377 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR, 7378 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1 7379 }; 7380 7381 /** 7382 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes 7383 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7384 * 7385 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag) 7386 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see 7387 * &enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32) 7388 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in 7389 * 802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element" 7390 * (u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7391 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units 7392 * of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0) 7393 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016 7394 * Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with 7395 * default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7396 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames 7397 * requested per burst 7398 * (u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference") 7399 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries 7400 * (u8, default 3) 7401 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag) 7402 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data 7403 * (flag) 7404 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging 7405 * measurement (flag). 7406 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are 7407 * mutually exclusive. 7408 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7409 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7410 * ranging will be used. 7411 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based 7412 * ranging measurement (flag) 7413 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are 7414 * mutually exclusive. 7415 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7416 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7417 * ranging will be used. 7418 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only 7419 * valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or 7420 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7421 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the 7422 * responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED 7423 * or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7424 * 7425 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal 7426 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7427 */ 7428 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req { 7429 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7430 7431 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP, 7432 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE, 7433 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7434 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD, 7435 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7436 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7437 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES, 7438 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI, 7439 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC, 7440 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7441 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7442 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK, 7443 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR, 7444 7445 /* keep last */ 7446 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR, 7447 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1 7448 }; 7449 7450 /** 7451 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons 7452 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used 7453 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder 7454 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement 7455 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is 7456 * on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd 7457 * try and get no response) 7458 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM 7459 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps 7460 * received 7461 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry 7462 * later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME) 7463 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed 7464 * by the peer and are no longer supported 7465 */ 7466 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons { 7467 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED, 7468 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE, 7469 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED, 7470 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL, 7471 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE, 7472 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP, 7473 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 7474 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS, 7475 }; 7476 7477 /** 7478 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes 7479 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7480 * 7481 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason 7482 * (u32, optional) 7483 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported 7484 * as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and 7485 * the top level will indicate partial results (u32) 7486 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames 7487 * transmitted (u32, optional) 7488 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames 7489 * that were acknowleged (u32, optional) 7490 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the 7491 * busy peer (u32, seconds) 7492 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent 7493 * used by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7494 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by 7495 * the responder (similar to request, u8) 7496 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used 7497 * by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7498 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action 7499 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7500 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action 7501 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7502 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the 7503 * FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info 7504 * attributes) 7505 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM 7506 * action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs) 7507 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional 7508 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7509 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that 7510 * standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7511 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds, 7512 * optional) 7513 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional 7514 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7515 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note 7516 * that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7517 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional) 7518 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional); 7519 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7520 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7521 * Type 8. 7522 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer 7523 * (binary, optional); 7524 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7525 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7526 * Type 11. 7527 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only 7528 * 7529 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal 7530 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7531 */ 7532 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp { 7533 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7534 7535 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON, 7536 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX, 7537 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS, 7538 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES, 7539 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME, 7540 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7541 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7542 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7543 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG, 7544 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD, 7545 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE, 7546 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE, 7547 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG, 7548 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE, 7549 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD, 7550 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG, 7551 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE, 7552 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD, 7553 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 7554 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 7555 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7556 7557 /* keep last */ 7558 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR, 7559 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1 7560 }; 7561 7562 /** 7563 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes 7564 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7565 * 7566 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset. 7567 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset. 7568 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum 7569 * tx power offset. 7570 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color 7571 * values used by members of the SRG. 7572 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial 7573 * BSSID values used by members of the SRG. 7574 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element. 7575 * 7576 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7577 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute. 7578 */ 7579 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes { 7580 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID, 7581 7582 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET, 7583 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET, 7584 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET, 7585 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 7586 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP, 7587 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL, 7588 7589 /* keep last */ 7590 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST, 7591 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7592 }; 7593 7594 /** 7595 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes 7596 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7597 * 7598 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color. 7599 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled. 7600 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used.. 7601 * 7602 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7603 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute. 7604 */ 7605 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes { 7606 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID, 7607 7608 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR, 7609 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED, 7610 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL, 7611 7612 /* keep last */ 7613 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST, 7614 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7615 }; 7616 7617 /** 7618 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes 7619 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7620 * 7621 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag 7622 * attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in 7623 * %NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES 7624 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported 7625 * AKM suites for the specified interface types. 7626 * 7627 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7628 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute. 7629 */ 7630 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes { 7631 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID, 7632 7633 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES, 7634 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES, 7635 7636 /* keep last */ 7637 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST, 7638 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7639 }; 7640 7641 /** 7642 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration 7643 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 7644 * 7645 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7646 * 7647 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU). 7648 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit) 7649 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7650 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled. 7651 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action 7652 * frame including the headers. 7653 * 7654 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7655 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7656 */ 7657 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes { 7658 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID, 7659 7660 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN, 7661 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX, 7662 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL, 7663 7664 /* keep last */ 7665 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST, 7666 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1 7667 }; 7668 7669 /* 7670 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and 7671 * mandatory fields. 7672 */ 7673 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42 7674 7675 /** 7676 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe 7677 * response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz. 7678 * 7679 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7680 * 7681 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7682 * Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 7683 * 26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is 7684 * disabled. 7685 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 7686 * frame template (binary). 7687 * 7688 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7689 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7690 */ 7691 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes { 7692 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7693 7694 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT, 7695 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL, 7696 7697 /* keep last */ 7698 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 7699 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX = 7700 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1 7701 }; 7702 7703 /** 7704 * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 7705 * derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is 7706 * used. 7707 * 7708 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that 7709 * attribute is not present from userspace. 7710 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only 7711 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only 7712 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element 7713 * can be used. 7714 */ 7715 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism { 7716 NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED, 7717 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK, 7718 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT, 7719 NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH, 7720 }; 7721 7722 /** 7723 * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs 7724 * 7725 * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit 7726 * 7727 */ 7728 enum nl80211_sar_type { 7729 NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER, 7730 7731 /* add new type here */ 7732 7733 /* Keep last */ 7734 NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE, 7735 }; 7736 7737 /** 7738 * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec 7739 * 7740 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type. 7741 * 7742 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power 7743 * limit specifications. Each specification contains a set 7744 * of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 7745 * 7746 * For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER 7747 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX. 7748 * 7749 * For sar_capa dump, it contains array of 7750 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ 7751 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ. 7752 * 7753 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7754 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute 7755 * 7756 * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC 7757 */ 7758 enum nl80211_sar_attrs { 7759 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID, 7760 7761 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE, 7762 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS, 7763 7764 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST, 7765 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7766 }; 7767 7768 /** 7769 * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs 7770 * 7771 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual 7772 * power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is 7773 * NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm). 7774 * 0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range. 7775 * 7776 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the 7777 * index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation 7778 * is applied to this range. 7779 * 7780 * Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver, 7781 * and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't 7782 * have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the 7783 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any 7784 * value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power 7785 * limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range. 7786 * It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation. 7787 * 7788 * Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation. 7789 * 7790 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start 7791 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7792 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7793 * 7794 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end 7795 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7796 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7797 * 7798 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal 7799 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute 7800 */ 7801 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs { 7802 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID, 7803 7804 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER, 7805 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX, 7806 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ, 7807 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ, 7808 7809 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST, 7810 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1, 7811 }; 7812 7813 /** 7814 * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced 7815 * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode. 7816 * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for 7817 * MBSSID and EMA. 7818 * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the 7819 * features. 7820 * 7821 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7822 * 7823 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise 7824 * the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver. 7825 * Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting 7826 * wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2. 7827 * 7828 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel 7829 * to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver 7830 * if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace 7831 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to 7832 * a non-zero value. 7833 * 7834 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of 7835 * this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set. 7836 * Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for 7837 * all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible 7838 * for using unique indices for the interfaces. 7839 * Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1. 7840 * 7841 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for 7842 * a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of 7843 * the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface 7844 * indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up 7845 * is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match 7846 * the interface index of the same. 7847 * 7848 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature. 7849 * Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support 7850 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero. 7851 * 7852 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7853 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7854 */ 7855 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes { 7856 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 7857 7858 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES, 7859 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY, 7860 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX, 7861 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX, 7862 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA, 7863 7864 /* keep last */ 7865 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST, 7866 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7867 }; 7868 7869 /** 7870 * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 7871 * 7872 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external 7873 * authentication. 7874 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query 7875 * procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises 7876 * %NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall 7877 * ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by 7878 * userspace. 7879 */ 7880 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags { 7881 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = 1 << 0, 7882 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT = 1 << 1, 7883 }; 7884 7885 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */ 7886